blob: 8827f9bb7f547eb026f4d594781b465d467f8139 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau86512dd2021-04-09 17:10:39 +02007 2021/04/09
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200897 - description
898 - deviceatlas-json-file
899 - deviceatlas-log-level
900 - deviceatlas-separator
901 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900902 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903 - gid
904 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100905 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200906 - h1-case-adjust
907 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100909 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100910 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200911 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200913 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100914 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200915 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100916 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100917 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200918 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200920 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100922 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200924 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100925 - presetenv
926 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200927 - uid
928 - ulimit-n
929 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200930 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100931 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100932 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200933 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200934 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200937 - ssl-default-bind-options
938 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200939 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200940 - ssl-default-server-options
941 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100942 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200943 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100944 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100945 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100946 - 51degrees-data-file
947 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200948 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200949 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200950 - wurfl-data-file
951 - wurfl-information-list
952 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200953 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100954 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100957 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200958 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200960 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100961 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100962 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100963 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200964 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200965 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200966 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200968 - noepoll
969 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000970 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100972 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300973 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000974 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100975 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200976 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200977 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200978 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000979 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000980 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - tune.buffers.limit
982 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200983 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200984 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100985 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200986 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200987 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200988 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200989 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100990 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200991 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200992 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200993 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100994 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100995 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100996 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100997 - tune.lua.session-timeout
998 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200999 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001000 - tune.maxaccept
1001 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001002 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001003 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001004 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001005 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1006 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001007 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1008 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001009 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001010 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001011 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001012 - tune.sndbuf.client
1013 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001014 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001015 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001016 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001017 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001018 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001019 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001020 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001021 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001022 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001023 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001024 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1025 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1026 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001027 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1028 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001029
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001032 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001033
1034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010353.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001036------------------------------------
1037
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001038ca-base <dir>
1039 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001040 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1041 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1042 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001044chroot <jail dir>
1045 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1046 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1047 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1048 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1049 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001050 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001051
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001052cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1053 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1054 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1055 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1056 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1057 set. These sets have the format
1058
1059 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1060
1061 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001063 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1064 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001065 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1066 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001067 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1068 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1069 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1070 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1071 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1072 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1073 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1074 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1075 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1076 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001077
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001078 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1079 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1080 on the machine's word size.
1081
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001082 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001083 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1084 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1085 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1086 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1087 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1088 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001089
1090 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001091 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1092
1093 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1094 # first 4 CPUs
1095
1096 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1097 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1098 # word size.
1099
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001100 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001101 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001102 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1103 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1104 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1105
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001106 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1107 # and so on.
1108 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1109 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1110 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1111
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001112 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001113 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1114 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1115 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1116
1117 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1118 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1119 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1120
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001121 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1122 # and a thread range.
1123 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1124 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1125 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1126
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001127crt-base <dir>
1128 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001129 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1130 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132daemon
1133 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1134 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001135 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1136 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001138deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1139 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001140 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001141
1142deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001144 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1145
1146deviceatlas-separator <char>
1147 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1148 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1149
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001150deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001151 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1152 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1153 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001154
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001155external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001156 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1157 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001158 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1159 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1160 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1161 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1162 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001165 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001166 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1167 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001168 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1169 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001170 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001171
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001172group <group name>
1173 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1174 See also "gid" and "user".
1175
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001176hard-stop-after <time>
1177 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1178
1179 Arguments :
1180 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1181 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1182 SIGUSR1 signal.
1183
1184 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1185 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1186 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1187
1188 Example:
1189 global
1190 hard-stop-after 30s
1191
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001192h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1193 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1194 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1195 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1196 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001197 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001198 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1199 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1200 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1201 specified in a proxy.
1202
1203 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1204 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1205 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1206 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1207 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1208 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1209 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1210
1211 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1212 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1213 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1214 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1215 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1216
1217 Example:
1218 global
1219 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1220
1221 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1222 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1223
1224h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1225 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1226 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1227 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1228 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1229 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1230 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1231 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1232 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1233
1234 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1235 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1236 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1237
1238 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1239 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1240
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001241insecure-fork-wanted
1242 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1243 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1244 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1245 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1246 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1247 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1248 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1249 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1250 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1251 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1252 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1253 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1254 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1255 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1256 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1257 disable it.
1258
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001259insecure-setuid-wanted
1260 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1261 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1262 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1263 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1264 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1265 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1266 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1267 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1268 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1269 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1270 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1271 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1272 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1273 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1274
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001275issuers-chain-path <dir>
1276 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1277 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1278 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1279 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1280 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1281 "issuers-chain-path".
1282 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1283 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1284 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1285 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1286 will share the chain in memory.
1287
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001288localpeer <name>
1289 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1290 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1291 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1292 the configuration parsing.
1293
1294 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1295 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1296
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001297log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001298 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001299 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001301 configured with "log global".
1302
1303 <address> can be one of:
1304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001305 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001306 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1307 port).
1308
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001309 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1310 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1311 port).
1312
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001313 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001314 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1315 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001316 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001317
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001318 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1319 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1320 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1321 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1322 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1323 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1324 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1325 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1326 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1327 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1328 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1329 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1330 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1331 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001332 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1333 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001334
1335 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1336 "fd@2", see above.
1337
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001338 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1339 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1340 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1341 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1342 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1343
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001344 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1345 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001346
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001347 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1348 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1349 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1350 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1351 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1352 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1353 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1354 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1355 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1356 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1358 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001359
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001360 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1361 one of the following :
1362
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001363 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1364 field is stripped. This is the default.
1365 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1366 rfc3164.
1367
1368 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001369 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1370
1371 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1372 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1373
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001374 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1375 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1376 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1377 designed to be used with a local log server.
1378
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001379 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1380 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1381 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1382 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1383 logger consumes.
1384
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001385 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1386 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1387 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1388 used with a local log server.
1389
1390 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1391 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1392 designed to be used with a local log server.
1393
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001394 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1395 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1396 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1397 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1398
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001399 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1400 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1401 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1402 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1403 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1404
1405 <sample_size>
1406 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1407 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1408 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1409 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1410 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1411
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001412 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001414 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1415 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1416 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1417
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001418 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1419 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1420 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1421 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422
1423 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001424 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1425 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1426 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1427 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1428 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1429 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001430
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001431 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001432
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001433log-send-hostname [<string>]
1434 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1435 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1436 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1437 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1438 the logs.
1439
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001440log-tag <string>
1441 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1442 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1443 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001444 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001445
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001446lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001447 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1448 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1449 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1450 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1451 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1452 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001453 used multiple times.
1454
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001455lua-load-per-thread <file>
1456 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1457 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1458 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1459 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1460 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1461 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1462 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1463 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1464 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1465 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1466 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1467 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1468 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1469 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1470 times.
1471
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001472lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1473 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1474 variable.
1475 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1476 to "path".
1477
1478 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1479 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1480 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1481 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1482 will be checked earlier.
1483
1484 As an example by specifying the following path:
1485
1486 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1487 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1488
1489 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1490 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1491 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1492 paths if that does not exist either.
1493
1494 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1495 documentation.
1496
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001497master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001498 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1499 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1500 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001501 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001502 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1503 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001504 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1505 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1506 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1507 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1508 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001509
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001510 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001511
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001512mworker-max-reloads <number>
1513 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001514 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001515 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1516 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1517 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1518
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001519nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001520 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1521 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1522 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001523 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1524 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001525 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1526 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1527 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001528
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001529nbthread <number>
1530 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001531 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1532 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1533 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1534 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1535 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001536 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1537 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1538 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1539 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1540 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1541 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1542 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001543
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001544numa-cpu-mapping
1545 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1546 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1547 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1548 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1549 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1550 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1551 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1552 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1553 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1554
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001555pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001556 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1557 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1558 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1559 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001560
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001561pp2-never-send-local
1562 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1563 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1564 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1565 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1566 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1567 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1568 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1569 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1570 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1571 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1572 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1573
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001574presetenv <name> <value>
1575 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1576 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1577 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1578 and "unsetenv".
1579
1580resetenv [<name> ...]
1581 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1582 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1583 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1584 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1585 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1586 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1587 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1588 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1589
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001590stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001591 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1592 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1593 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1594 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1595 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1596 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001597 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001598 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1599 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1600 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1601 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001602
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001603server-state-base <directory>
1604 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001605 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1606 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001607
1608server-state-file <file>
1609 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1610 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1611 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1612 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1613 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1614 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1615 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1616 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001617 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1618 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001619
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001620set-var <var-name> <expr>
1621 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1622 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1623 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1624 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1625 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1626 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1627 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1628 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1629 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1630
1631 Example:
1632 global
1633 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1634 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1635 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1636
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001637setenv <name> <value>
1638 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1639 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1640 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1641 and "unsetenv".
1642
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001643set-dumpable
1644 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001645 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1646 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1647 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1648 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1649 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1650 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1651 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1652 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1653 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1654 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1655 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1656 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1657 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1658 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1659 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1660 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1661 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001662
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001663ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1665 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001666 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001667 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001668 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1669 information and recommendations see e.g.
1670 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1671 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1672 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1673 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001674
1675ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1677 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1678 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1679 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1680 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001681 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1682 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1683 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001684 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001685
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001686ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1688 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1689 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1690 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1691 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1692
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001693ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1695 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1696 keyword to see available options.
1697
1698 Example:
1699 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001700 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001701
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001702ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1704 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001705 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001706 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001707 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1708 information and recommendations see e.g.
1709 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1710 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1711 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1712 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1713 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001714
1715ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1717 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1718 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1719 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1720 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001721 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1722 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1723 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1724 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001725
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001726ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1728 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1729 keyword to see available options.
1730
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001731ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1733 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1734 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001735 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001736 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001737 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1738 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1739 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1740 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001741 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1742 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1743 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1744
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001745ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1746 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1747 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001748 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001749 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001750 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1751
1752 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001753
1754 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1755 and won't try to remove them.
1756
1757 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1758
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001759ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001760 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001761 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1762 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001763
1764 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1765 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1766 optimize the startup time.
1767
1768 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1769 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1770 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1771
1772 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001773 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001774
1775 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001776 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1777
1778 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1779 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1780 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1781 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1782 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1783 bind configuration..
1784
1785 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1786 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1787 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1788 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1789 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1790 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1791 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1792 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1793
1794 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1795
1796 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1797 a cert bundle.
1798
1799 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1800 separately in several "crt".
1801
1802 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1803 since files are loading separately.
1804
1805 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1806 required to commit them.
1807
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001808 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001809 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001810
1811 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1812
1813 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1814
1815 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1816 not provided in the PEM file.
1817
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001818 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1819 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1820
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001821 The default behavior is "all".
1822
1823 Example:
1824 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1825 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1826 ssl-load-extra-files none
1827
1828 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1829
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001830ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1831 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1832 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1833 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1834
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001835ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001836 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001837 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1838 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1839 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1840 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1841 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1842 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001843 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001844
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001845stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1846 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1847 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1848 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001849 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001850 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001851
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001852 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1853 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1854 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001855
1856stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1857 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1858 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001859 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001860
1861stats maxconn <connections>
1862 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1863 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1864
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001865uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001866 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001867 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1868 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1869 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1870
1871ulimit-n <number>
1872 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1873 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1874 option.
1875
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1877 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1878
1879 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1880 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1881 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1882 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1883 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1884 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1885 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1886 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1887 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1888 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1889
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001890unsetenv [<name> ...]
1891 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1892 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1893 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1894 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1895 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1896 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1897 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1898
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001899user <user name>
1900 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1901 See also "uid" and "group".
1902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001903node <name>
1904 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1905
1906 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1907 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1908 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1909 traffic.
1910
1911description <text>
1912 Add a text that describes the instance.
1913
1914 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1915 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1916 "<" and ">" characters.
1917
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100191851degrees-data-file <file path>
1919 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001920 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001921
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001922 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001923 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1924
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000192551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001926 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1927 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1928 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1929
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001930 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001931 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1932
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200193351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001934 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1935 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1936
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001937 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1938 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1939
194051degrees-cache-size <number>
1941 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1942 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1943 By default, this cache is disabled.
1944
1945 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001946 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1947
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001948wurfl-data-file <file path>
1949 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1950 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1951
1952 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1953 with USE_WURFL=1.
1954
1955wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1956 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1957 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1958 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1959
1960 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1961
1962 Valid WURFL properties are:
1963 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1964
1965 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1966 device.
1967
1968 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1969 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1970
1971 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1972 particular web request.
1973
1974 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1975 used Libwurfl API version.
1976
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001977 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1978 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1979
1980 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1981 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1982
1983 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1984
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1986 with USE_WURFL=1.
1987
1988wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1989 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1990 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1991
1992 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1993 with USE_WURFL=1.
1994
1995wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1996 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1997 thus before the chroot.
1998
1999 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2000 with USE_WURFL=1.
2001
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002002wurfl-cache-size <size>
2003 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2004 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002005 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002006 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002007
2008 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2009 with USE_WURFL=1.
2010
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002011strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002012 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2013 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2014 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2015 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2016 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020183.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002019-----------------------
2020
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002021busy-polling
2022 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2023 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2024 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2025 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2026 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2027 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2028 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2029 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2030 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2031 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2032 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2033 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2034 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2035 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2036 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2037 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2038 "poll" pollers.
2039
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002040 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2041 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2042 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2043
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002044max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2045 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2046 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2047 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2048 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2049 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2050 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2051 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2052 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2053
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054maxconn <number>
2055 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2056 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2057 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002058 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2059 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2060 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2061 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002062 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2063 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2064 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2065 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2066 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2067 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002068
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002069maxconnrate <number>
2070 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2071 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2072 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2073 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2074 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2075 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2076 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2077 fairness.
2078
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002079maxcomprate <number>
2080 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002081 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002082 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2083 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2084 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002085 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002086 default value.
2087
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002088maxcompcpuusage <number>
2089 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2090 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2091 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2092 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2093 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2094 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2095 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2096 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2097
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002098maxpipes <number>
2099 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2100 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2101 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2102 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2103 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2104 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2105
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002106maxsessrate <number>
2107 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2108 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2109 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2110 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2111 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2112 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2113 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2114 fairness.
2115
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002116maxsslconn <number>
2117 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2118 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2119 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2120 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2121 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2122 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2123 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002124 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2125 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2126 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2127 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2128 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2129 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2130 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002131
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002132maxsslrate <number>
2133 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2134 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2135 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2136 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2137 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2138 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2139 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2140 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2141 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2142 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2143
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002144maxzlibmem <number>
2145 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2146 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2147 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002148 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2149 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2150 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002152noepoll
2153 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2154 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002155 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002156
2157nokqueue
2158 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2159 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2160 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2161
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002162noevports
2163 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2164 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2165 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2166 also "nopoll".
2167
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002168nopoll
2169 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2170 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002172 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2173 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002175nosplice
2176 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002178 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002179 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002180 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2181 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2182 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2183 "option splice-response".
2184
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002185nogetaddrinfo
2186 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2187 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2188
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002189noreuseport
2190 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2191 command line argument "-dR".
2192
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002193profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2194 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2195 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2196 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2197 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002198 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002199 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2200 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2201 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2202 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2203
2204 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2205 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2206 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2207 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2208 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002209 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2210 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2211 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2212 CLI.
2213
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002214spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002215 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2216 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2217 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2218 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2219 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2220 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002223 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002224 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002225 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2226 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2227 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2228 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2229 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002230 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2231 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002232 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2233 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2234 openssl configuration file uses:
2235 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2236
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002237ssl-mode-async
2238 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002239 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002240 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2241 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2242 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002243 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002244 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002245
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002246tune.buffers.limit <number>
2247 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2248 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2249 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2250 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2251 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002252 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002253 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2254 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2255 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2256 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2257 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2258 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2259 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2260 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2261 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2262
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002263tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2264 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2265 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2266 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2267 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2268
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002269tune.bufsize <number>
2270 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2271 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2272 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2273 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2274 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2275 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2276 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002277 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2278 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2279 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002280 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002281 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2282 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2283 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002284
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002285tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2286 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002287
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002288tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2289 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2290 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2291 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2292 this value. The default value is 1.
2293
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002294tune.fail-alloc
2295 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2296 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2297 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2298 gracefully.
2299
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002300tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2301 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2302 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2303 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2304 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2305 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2306
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002307tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2308 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2309 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2310 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2311 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2312 change it.
2313
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002314tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2315 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002316 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2317 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002318 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2319 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2320 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2321 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2322 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2323
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002324tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2325 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2326 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2327 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2328 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2329 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2330 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2331 recommended not to change this value.
2332
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002333tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2334 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2335 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2336 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2337 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2338 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2339 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2340 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2341
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002342tune.http.cookielen <number>
2343 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2344 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2345 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2346 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2347 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2348 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2349 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2350 to change this value.
2351
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002352tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002353 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2354 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002355 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002356 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002357 configuration directives too.
2358 The default value is 1024.
2359
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002360tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2361 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2362 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2363 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2364 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2365 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2366 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002367 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2368 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2369 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002370
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002371tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2372 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2373 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2374 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2375 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2376 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2377 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002378 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2379 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2380 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2381 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2382 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002383
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002384tune.idletimer <timeout>
2385 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2386 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2387 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2388 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2389 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2390 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002391 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002392 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002393 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2394
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002395tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2396 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2397 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2398 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2399 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2400 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2401 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2402 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2403 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2404 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2405
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002406tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2407 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002408 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002409 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2410 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002412 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2413 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2414
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002415tune.lua.maxmem
2416 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2417 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2418 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2419 memory.
2420
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002421tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2422 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002423 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2424 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002425 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002426
2427tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2428 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2429 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2430 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2431 check servers.
2432
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002433tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2434 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2435 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2436 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002437 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002438
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002439tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002440 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2441 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002442 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2443 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2444 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2445 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2446 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2447 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2448 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2449 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2450 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002451
2452tune.maxpollevents <number>
2453 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2454 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2455 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2456 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2457 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2458
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002459tune.maxrewrite <number>
2460 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2461 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2462 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2463 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2464 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2465 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2466 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2467 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2468 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2469 bufsize.
2470
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002471tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2472 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2473 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2474 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2475 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2476 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2477 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2478 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2479 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2480 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002481 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2482 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002483 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2484 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2485 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2486 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2487 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2488 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2489 setting this parameter to 0.
2490
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002491tune.pipesize <number>
2492 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2493 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2494 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2495 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2496 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2497 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2498
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002499tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2500 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2501 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2502 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2503 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2504 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2505 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002506 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002507
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002508tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2509 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2510 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2511 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2512 default is 20.
2513
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002514tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2515tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2516 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2517 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2518 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002519 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002520 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002521 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2522 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2523
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002524tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002525 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002526 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2527 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2528 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2529 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2530
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002531tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002532 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002533 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2534 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2535 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2536 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2537 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2538 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2539 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002540
2541tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2542 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2543 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2544 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2545 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2546 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2547 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2548 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2549 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2550 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002551
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002552tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2553tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2554 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2555 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2556 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002557 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002558 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002559 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2560 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2561 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2562 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2563 notifying haproxy again.
2564
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002565tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002566 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002567 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2568 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2569 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2570 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2571 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2572 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2573 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2574 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2575 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2576 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2577 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002578
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002579tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002580 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002581 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2582 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2583 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2584 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2585 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2586
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002587tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2588 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2589 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2590 performances. This is disabled by default.
2591
2592 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2593 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2594
2595 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2596
2597 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2598
2599 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2600
2601 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2602 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2603 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2604
2605 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2606 converted.
2607
2608 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2609 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2610 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2611 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2612 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2613 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2614 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002615 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2616 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002617
2618 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2619
2620 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2621 only need this line:
2622
2623 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2624
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002625tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2626 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002627 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002628 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2629 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2630 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2631 being used for too long.
2632
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002633tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2635 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2636 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2637 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2638 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2639 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2640 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2641 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2642 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2643 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002644 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002645 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002646
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002647tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2648 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2649 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2650 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2651 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002652 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002653 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2654 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002655 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2656 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002657
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002658tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2659 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2660 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2661 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2662 1000 entries.
2663
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002664tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2665 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2666 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2667 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2668
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002669tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002670tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002671tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2672tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2673tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002674 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2675 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2676 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2677 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2678 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2679 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2680 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2681 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002682
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002683 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2684 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2685 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2686 all available space is consumed.
2687 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2688 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2689 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002690
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002691tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2692 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002693 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002694 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002695 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002696 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2697
2698tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2699 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2700 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2702 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027043.3. Debugging
2705--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002707quiet
2708 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2709 line argument "-q".
2710
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002711zero-warning
2712 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2713 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2714 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2715 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2716 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2717 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2718
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027203.4. Userlists
2721--------------
2722It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2723http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2724it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2725
2726userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002727 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002728 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2729
2730group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002731 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002732 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2733 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2734
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002735user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2736 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002737 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2738 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002739 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2740 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2741 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2742 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002743
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002744 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2745 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2746 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2747 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2748 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2749 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2750 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2751 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2752 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002753
2754 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002755 userlist L1
2756 group G1 users tiger,scott
2757 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002758
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002759 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2760 user scott insecure-password elgato
2761 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002762
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002763 userlist L2
2764 group G1
2765 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002766
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002767 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2768 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2769 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002770
2771 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002772
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002773
27743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002775----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002776It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2777several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2778instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2779values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2780automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2781In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2782using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2783tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2784reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2785Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2786that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2787each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002788
2789peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002790 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002791 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2792
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002793bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2794 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2795 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2796
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002797disabled
2798 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2799 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2800 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2801
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002802default-bind [param*]
2803 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2804
2805default-server [param*]
2806 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2807
2808 Arguments:
2809 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2810 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2811 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2812 details.
2813
2814
2815 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2816
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002817enable
2818 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2819
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002820log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002821 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2822 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2823 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2824 more details.
2825
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002826peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002827 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2828 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002829 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2830 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2831 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2832 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2833 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002834
2835 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2836 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2837
2838 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002839 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2840 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2841 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002842
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2844 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002845
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002846 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2847 "server" keyword explanation below).
2848
2849server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002850 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002851 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2852 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2853 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2854 of this "peers" section).
2855 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2856
2857
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002858 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002859 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002860 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002861 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2862 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2863 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002864
2865 backend mybackend
2866 mode tcp
2867 balance roundrobin
2868 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2869 stick on src
2870
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002871 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2872 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002873
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002874 Example:
2875 peers mypeers
2876 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2877 default-server ssl verify none
2878 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2879 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002880
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002881
2882table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2883 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2884
2885 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2886 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002887 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002888 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2889 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2890 "stick-table" keyword).
2891
2892 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2893 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2894 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2895 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2896 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2897 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2898 of the stick-table name as follows:
2899
2900 peers mypeers
2901 peer A ...
2902 peer B ...
2903 table t1 ...
2904
2905 frontend fe1
2906 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2907
2908 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2909 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2910
2911 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2912 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2913 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2914 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2915 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2916 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2917 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2918
2919 peers mypeers
2920 peer A ...
2921 peer B ...
2922 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2923
2924 backend t1
2925 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2926
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002927 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002928 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2929 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2930
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029313.6. Mailers
2932------------
2933It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2934If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2935in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2936
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002937mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002938 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2939 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2940
2941mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2942 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2943
2944 Example:
2945 mailers mymailers
2946 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2947 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2948
2949 backend mybackend
2950 mode tcp
2951 balance roundrobin
2952
2953 email-alert mailers mymailers
2954 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2955 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2956
2957 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2958 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2959
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002960timeout mail <time>
2961 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2962 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2963 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2964 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2965
2966 Example:
2967 mailers mymailers
2968 timeout mail 20s
2969 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002970
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029713.7. Programs
2972-------------
2973In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2974master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2975managed the same way as the workers.
2976
2977During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2978sequence as a worker:
2979
2980 - the master is re-executed
2981 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2982 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2983 instance of the program
2984
2985During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2986
2987program <name>
2988 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2989 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2990 the management guide).
2991
2992command <command> [arguments*]
2993 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2994 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2995 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2996 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2997
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002998user <user name>
2999 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3000 See also "group".
3001
3002group <group name>
3003 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3004 See also "user".
3005
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003006option start-on-reload
3007no option start-on-reload
3008 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3009 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3010 program section.
3011
3012
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010030133.8. HTTP-errors
3014----------------
3015
3016It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3017imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3018several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3019
3020http-errors <name>
3021 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3022 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3023
3024errorfile <code> <file>
3025 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3026
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003029 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003030 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003031
3032 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3033 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3034 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3035 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3036 before any chroot is performed.
3037
3038 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3039
3040 Example:
3041 http-errors website-1
3042 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3043 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3044 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3045
3046 http-errors website-2
3047 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3048 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3049 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3050
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030513.9. Rings
3052----------
3053
3054It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3055servers or traces.
3056
3057ring <ringname>
3058 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3059
3060description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003061 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003062 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3063
3064format <format>
3065 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3066
3067 Arguments:
3068 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3069 one of the following :
3070
3071 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3072 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3073 designed to be used with a local log server.
3074
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003075 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3076 field is stripped. This is the default.
3077 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3078 rfc3164.
3079
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003080 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3081 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3082 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3083 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3084 is the default.
3085
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003086 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003087 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3088
3089 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3090 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3091
3092 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3093 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3094 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3095 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3096 logger consumes.
3097
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003098 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3099 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3100 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3101 with a local log server.
3102
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003103 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3104 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3105 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3106 used with a local log server.
3107
3108maxlen <length>
3109 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3110 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3111 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3112
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003113server <name> <address> [param*]
3114 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3115 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3116 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3117 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3118 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3119 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3120 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3121 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3122 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003123 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3124 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003125
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003126size <size>
3127 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3128 set to BUFSIZE.
3129
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003130timeout connect <timeout>
3131 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3132
3133 Arguments :
3134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3136 as explained at the top of this document.
3137
3138timeout server <timeout>
3139 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3140
3141 Arguments :
3142 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3143 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3144 as explained at the top of this document.
3145
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003146 Example:
3147 global
3148 log ring@myring local7
3149
3150 ring myring
3151 description "My local buffer"
3152 format rfc3164
3153 maxlen 1200
3154 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003155 timeout connect 5s
3156 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003157 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003158
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031593.10. Log forwarding
3160-------------------
3161
3162It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3163haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3164
3165log-forward <name>
3166 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3167
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003168backlog <conns>
3169 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3170 on connections accept.
3171
3172bind <addr> [param*]
3173 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003174 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3175 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3176 syslog protocol over TCP.
3177 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003178 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3179
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003180dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003181 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3182 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3183 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3184 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003185 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003186
3187log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003188log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003189 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3190 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3191 documentation.
3192 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3193 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3194 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3195 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3196 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3197
3198 Example:
3199 global
3200 log stderr format iso local7
3201
3202 ring myring
3203 description "My local buffer"
3204 format rfc5424
3205 maxlen 1200
3206 size 32764
3207 timeout connect 5s
3208 timeout server 10s
3209 # syslog tcp server
3210 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3211
3212 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003213 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3214 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003215 # all messages on stderr
3216 log global
3217 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3218 log ring@myring local0
3219 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3220 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3221 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3222 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3223 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003224
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003225maxconn <conns>
3226 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3227 10 is the default.
3228
3229timeout client <timeout>
3230 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032324. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003233----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003234
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003235Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003236 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3237 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3238 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3239 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003240
3241A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3242connections.
3243
3244A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3245to forward incoming connections.
3246
3247A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3248parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3249
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003250A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3251ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3252sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3253the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3254explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3255from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3256"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3257for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3258to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3259optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3260are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3261any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3262names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3263that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3264duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3265names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3266
3267Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3268settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3269of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3270profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3271timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3274'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3275case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3276
3277Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3278logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3279proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3280However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3281name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3282
3283Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3284and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003285bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3287modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3288arbitrary criteria.
3289
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003290In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3291a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003292the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003293
3294 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3295 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3296 between responses and new requests.
3297
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003298 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3299 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3300 client-facing connection remains open.
3301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003302 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3303 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003304
3305The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3306frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3307following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003308weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003309
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003310 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003311
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003312 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3313 ----+-----+-----+----
3314 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3315 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003316 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3317 ----+-----+-----+----
3318 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003319
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003320It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3321only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3322into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3323as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3324content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3325and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3326possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003328There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3329first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3330processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3331second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3332protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3333is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3334new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3335to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3336process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3337already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3338HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3339evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3340one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3341
3342There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3343performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3344tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3345preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3346analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3347HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3348header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3349mitigate this drawback.
3350
3351It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3352method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3353set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3354in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3355is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3356to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3357above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3358to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3359"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3360frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3361frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3362as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3363upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3364on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3365the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3366upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3367frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3368remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033704.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3371--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003373The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3374limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3375they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3376limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003378option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003379and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3380with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3381specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003383
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3385------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3386acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003387backlog X X X -
3388balance X - X X
3389bind - X X -
3390bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003391capture cookie - X X -
3392capture request header - X X -
3393capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003394clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3395clitcpka-idle X X X -
3396clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003397compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003398cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003399declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003400default-server X - X X
3401default_backend X X X -
3402description - X X X
3403disabled X X X X
3404dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003405email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003406email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003407email-alert mailers X X X X
3408email-alert myhostname X X X X
3409email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003410enabled X X X X
3411errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003412errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003413errorloc X X X X
3414errorloc302 X X X X
3415-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3416errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003417force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003418filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003419fullconn X - X X
3420grace X X X X
3421hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003422http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003423http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003424http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003425http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003426http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003427http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003428http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003429http-check set-var X - X X
3430http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003431http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003432http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003433http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003434http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003435http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003436id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003437ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003438load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003439log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003440log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003441log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003442log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003443max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444maxconn X X X -
3445mode X X X X
3446monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003447monitor-uri X X X -
3448option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3449option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3450option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3451option allbackups (*) X - X X
3452option checkcache (*) X - X X
3453option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3454option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003455option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003456option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3457option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003458-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3459option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003460option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3461option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003462option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003463option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003464option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003465option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003466option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003467option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3468option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3469option httpchk X - X X
3470option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003471option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003472option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003473option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003474option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003475option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003476option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3477option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3478option logasap (*) X X X -
3479option mysql-check X - X X
3480option nolinger (*) X X X X
3481option originalto X X X X
3482option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003483option pgsql-check X - X X
3484option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003485option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003486option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003487option smtpchk X - X X
3488option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3489option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3490option splice-request (*) X X X X
3491option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003492option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003493option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3494option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3495-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003496option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003497option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3498option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3499option tcpka X X X X
3500option tcplog X X X X
3501option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003502external-check command X - X X
3503external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003504persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3505rate-limit sessions X X X -
3506redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003507-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003508retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003509retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003510server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003511server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003512server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003513source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003514srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3515srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3516srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003517stats admin - X X X
3518stats auth X X X X
3519stats enable X X X X
3520stats hide-version X X X X
3521stats http-request - X X X
3522stats realm X X X X
3523stats refresh X X X X
3524stats scope X X X X
3525stats show-desc X X X X
3526stats show-legends X X X X
3527stats show-node X X X X
3528stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3530stick match - - X X
3531stick on - - X X
3532stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003533stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003534stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003535tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003536tcp-check connect X - X X
3537tcp-check expect X - X X
3538tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003539tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003540tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003541tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003542tcp-check set-var X - X X
3543tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003544tcp-request connection - X X -
3545tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003546tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003547tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003548tcp-response content - - X X
3549tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550timeout check X - X X
3551timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003552timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003554timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3555timeout http-request X X X X
3556timeout queue X - X X
3557timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003558timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003560timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003561transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003562unique-id-format X X X -
3563unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003564use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003565use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003566use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3568 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3572---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573
3574This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3575
3576
3577acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3578 Declare or complete an access list.
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 no | yes | yes | yes
3581 Example:
3582 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3583 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3584 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003586 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003587
3588
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003589backlog <conns>
3590 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | no
3593 Arguments :
3594 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3595 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003596 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003597
3598 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3599 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3600 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3601 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3602 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3603 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3604 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3605 backlog parameter.
3606
3607 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3608 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3609 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3610
3611 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3612
3613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003615balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | no | yes | yes
3619 Arguments :
3620 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3621 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3622 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3623 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3624
3625 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3626 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3627 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3628 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003629 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003630 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003631 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3632 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3633 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3634 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3635 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3636 it, so that you don't worry.
3637
3638 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3639 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3640 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3641 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3642 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3643 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3644 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3645 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003647 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3648 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3649 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3650 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3651 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3652 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3653 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003654 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3655 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3656 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003657
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003658 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003659 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003660 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3661 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003662 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003663 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3664 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3665 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3666 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3667 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003668 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3669 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3670 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3671 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3672 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3673 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3676 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3677 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3678 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3679 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3680 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3681 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3682 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003683 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003685 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3686 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3687 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003689 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3690 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3691 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3692 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3693 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3694 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3695 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3696 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3697 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3698 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3699 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3700 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003701
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003702 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003703 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3704 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3705 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3706 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3707 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3708 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3709 URIs start with a leading "/".
3710
3711 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3712 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3713 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3714 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3715
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003716 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3717 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3718 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3719 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003721 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003722 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3723
3724 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003725 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3726 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003727 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3728 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3729 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3730 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003731 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003732 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3733 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003734
3735 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3736 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3737 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3738 server will receive the request.
3739
3740 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3741 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3742 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3743 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3744 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003745 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3746 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3747 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003748
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003749 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3750 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3751 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3752 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3753 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003755 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003756 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3757 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3758 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3759
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003760 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3761 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3762 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3763
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003764 random
3765 random(<draws>)
3766 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003767 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3768 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3769 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3770 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003771 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3772 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3773 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3774 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3775 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3776 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3777 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3778 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3779 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3780 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3781 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3782 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3783 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3784 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3785 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3786 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3787 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3788 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3789 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3790 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003791
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003792 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003793 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003794 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3795 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3796 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3797 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3798 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3799 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003800 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003801 used instead.
3802
3803 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3804 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3805 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3806 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3807
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003808 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3809 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3810 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3811
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003812 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003814 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003815 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3816 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003817
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003818 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3819 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3820 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003822 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003823 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003824 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3825 NTLM relies on.
3826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827 Examples :
3828 balance roundrobin
3829 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003830 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003831 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3832 balance hdr(host)
3833 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003834
3835 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3836 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003838 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003839 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3840 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3841 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003842 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003843
3844 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3845 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3846 defaults to 16 kB.
3847
3848 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3849 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3850
3851 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3852 Round Robin.
3853
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003854 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003855 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3856 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3857 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3858
3859 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3860
3861 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003862 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003863 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3864 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3865 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003867 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868
3869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003870bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3871bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 no | yes | yes | no
3875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003876 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3877 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3878 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3879 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003880 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003881 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3882 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3883 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3884 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3885 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3886 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003887 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003888 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3889 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003890 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003891 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3892 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003893 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003894 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3895 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003896 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003897 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3898 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3899 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3900 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3901 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3902 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3903 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003904 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3905 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3906 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003907 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3908 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3909 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3910 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003911 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3912 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3913 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003914
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003915 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3916 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003917 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3918 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3919 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003920 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3921 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3922 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3923 the range.
3924
3925 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3926 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3927 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3928 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3929 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3930 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3931 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003932 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003933 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003935 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003936 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003937 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3938 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3939 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3940 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3941 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3942 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003944 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3945 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3946 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3947 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3950 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3951 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3952 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3953 in a frontend.
3954
3955 Example :
3956 listen http_proxy
3957 bind :80,:443
3958 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003959 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003961 listen http_https_proxy
3962 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003963 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003964
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003965 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3966 bind ipv6@:80
3967 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3968 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3969
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003970 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003971 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003972
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003973 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3974 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3975 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3976 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3977 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3978
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003979 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003980 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003981
3982
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003983bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003984 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | yes | yes | yes
3987 Arguments :
3988 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3989 may be used to override a default value.
3990
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003991 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003992 option may be combined with other numbers.
3993
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003994 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003995 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3996 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3997 missing from all processes.
3998
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003999 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004000 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004001 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4002 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4003 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4004 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4005 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004006 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004007
4008 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4009 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4010 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4011 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4012 and 'even' instances.
4013
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004014 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4015 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4016 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4017 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004018
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004019 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4020 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4021
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004022 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4023 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4024 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4025
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004026 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4027 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4028
4029 Example :
4030 listen app_ip1
4031 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004032 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004033
4034 listen app_ip2
4035 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004036 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004037
4038 listen management
4039 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004040 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004041
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004042 listen management
4043 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4044 bind-process 1-4
4045
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004046 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004047
4048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004049capture cookie <name> len <length>
4050 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 no | yes | yes | no
4053 Arguments :
4054 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4055 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4056 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4057 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004058 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004059
4060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4061 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4062 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4063 right if it exceeds <length>.
4064
4065 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4066 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4067 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4068 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4069
4070 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4071 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4072 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4073
4074 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4075 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4076 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004077 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4078 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4079 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004080
4081 Example:
4082 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4083
4084 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004086
4087
4088capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004089 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4091 no | yes | yes | no
4092 Arguments :
4093 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004094 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4096 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4097 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4098
4099 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4100 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4101 it exceeds <length>.
4102
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004103 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4105 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004106 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4107 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4108 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4109 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004110 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004111 environments to find where the request came from.
4112
4113 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4114 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4115 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4116 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004117
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004118 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4119 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4120 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4121 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4122 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123
4124 Example:
4125 capture request header Host len 15
4126 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004127 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004129 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130 about logging.
4131
4132
4133capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004134 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 no | yes | yes | no
4137 Arguments :
4138 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004139 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004140 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4141 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4142 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4143
4144 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4145 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4146 it exceeds <length>.
4147
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004148 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004149 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4150 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4151 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004152 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4153 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4154 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4155 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004156
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004157 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4158 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4159 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4160 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4161 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162
4163 Example:
4164 capture response header Content-length len 9
4165 capture response header Location len 15
4166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004167 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168 about logging.
4169
4170
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004171clitcpka-cnt <count>
4172 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4173 the connection on the client side.
4174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4175 yes | yes | yes | no
4176 Arguments :
4177 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4178
4179 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4180 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004181 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4182 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004183
4184 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4185
4186
4187clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4188 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4189 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4190 client side.
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | no
4193 Arguments :
4194 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4195 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4196 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4197 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4198
4199 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4200 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004201 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4202 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004203
4204 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4205
4206
4207clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4208 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4210 yes | yes | yes | no
4211 Arguments :
4212 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4213 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4214 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4215 document.
4216
4217 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4218 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004219 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4220 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004221
4222 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4223
4224
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004225compression algo <algorithm> ...
4226compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004227compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004228 Enable HTTP compression.
4229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4230 yes | yes | yes | yes
4231 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004232 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4233 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4234 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4235
4236 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004237 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4238 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4239 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004240
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004241 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004242 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004243
4244 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4245 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4246 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4247 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4248 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004249 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004250
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004251 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4252 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4253 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4254 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4255 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4256 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4257 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004258 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004259
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004260 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004261 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004262 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4263 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4264 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4265 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4266 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004267
4268 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4269 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4270 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4271 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4272 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004273 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4274 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4275 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4276 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4277 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004278 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4279 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004280
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004281 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004282 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4283 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004284 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004285 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004286 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4287 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4288 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4289 "multipart"
4290 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4291 header
4292 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4293 and later
4294 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4295 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004296 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004297
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004298 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004299
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004300 Examples :
4301 compression algo gzip
4302 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004304
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004305cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004306 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4307 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004308 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | no | yes | yes
4312 Arguments :
4313 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4314 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4315 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4316 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4317 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4318 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004319 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4321 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4322
4323 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4324 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4325 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4326 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4327 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4328 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004329 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4330 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004331 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004332 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4333 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334
4335 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004336 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004337
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004338 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004339 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004340 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004341 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004342 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4343 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4344 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4345 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4346 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4347 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4348 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
4350 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4351 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4352 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4353 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4354 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4355 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4356 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4357 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4358 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004359 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004360 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4361 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4362 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004363
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004364 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4365 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4366 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004367 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4368 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4369 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4370 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004371 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4372 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4373 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004374
4375 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4376 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4377 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4378 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4379 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4380 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4381 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4382 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4383 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4384
4385 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4386 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4387 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4388 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4389 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4390 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4391 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4392 persistence cookie in the cache.
4393 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4394
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004395 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4396 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4397 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4398 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4399 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004400 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004401 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4402 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4403 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4404 they logout.
4405
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004406 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4407 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4408 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4409 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4410
4411 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4412 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4413 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4414 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4415 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4416 this attribute.
4417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004418 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004419 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004420 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4421 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4422 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4423 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4424 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4425 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004426
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004427 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4428 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4429 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4430 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4431 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4432 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4433 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4434 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004435 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004436 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4437 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4438 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4439 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4440 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4441 the site.
4442
4443 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4444 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4445 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4446 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4447 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4448 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4449 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4450 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4451 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4452 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4453 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4454 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4455 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004456 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004457 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4458 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4459
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004460 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4461 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4462 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4463 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4464 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4465 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4466
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004467 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4468 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4469 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4470 repeated.
4471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4473 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4474 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4475 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004477 Examples :
4478 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4479 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4480 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004481 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004482
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004483 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004484
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004485
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004486declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4487 Declares a capture slot.
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4489 no | yes | yes | no
4490 Arguments:
4491 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4492
4493 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4494 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4495 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4496 for use in the response.
4497
4498 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004499 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004500 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4501
4502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004503default-server [param*]
4504 Change default options for a server in a backend
4505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 yes | no | yes | yes
4507 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004508 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4509 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4510 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4511 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004512
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004513 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004514 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4515
4516 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519default_backend <backend>
4520 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | no
4523 Arguments :
4524 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4525
4526 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4527 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4528 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4529 will catch all undetermined requests.
4530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004531 Example :
4532
4533 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4534 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4535 default_backend dynamic
4536
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004537 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004540description <string>
4541 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 no | yes | yes | yes
4544 Arguments : string
4545
4546 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4547 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4548 it describes.
4549 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4550
4551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552disabled
4553 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4555 yes | yes | yes | yes
4556 Arguments : none
4557
4558 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4559 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4560 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4561 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4562 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4563 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4564 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4565
4566 See also : "enabled"
4567
4568
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004569dispatch <address>:<port>
4570 Set a default server address
4571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4572 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004573 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004574
4575 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4576 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4577 during start-up.
4578
4579 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4580 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4581 possible with normal servers.
4582
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004583 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004584 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4585 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4586 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4587 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4588
4589 See also : "server"
4590
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004591
4592dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4593 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
4596 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4597
4598 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004599 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004600 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4601 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004602 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004603 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605enabled
4606 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments : none
4610
4611 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4612 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4613
4614 See also : "disabled"
4615
4616
4617errorfile <code> <file>
4618 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | yes
4621 Arguments :
4622 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004623 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004624 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004625
4626 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004627 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004629 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4630 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004631
4632 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4633 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4634 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4635
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004636 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4637
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004638 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4639 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4640 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4641 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4642 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4643 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4644 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4645 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4646 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004648 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4649 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4650 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004651 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004652 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4653
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004654 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004656 Example :
4657 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004658 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004659 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4660 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004662
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004663errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4664 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4665 section.
4666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | yes | yes | yes
4668 Arguments :
4669 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4670
4671 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004672 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004673 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4674 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004675
4676 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4677 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4678 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4679 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4680 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004681 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004682 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4683
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004684 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4685 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004686
4687 Example :
4688 errorfiles generic
4689 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4690
4691
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004692errorloc <code> <url>
4693errorloc302 <code> <url>
4694 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
4698 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004699 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004700 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701
4702 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4703 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4704 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4705 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004706 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707
4708 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4709 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4710 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4711
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004712 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004714 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4715 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4716 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4717 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004718 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4720 request.
4721
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004722 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004723
4724
4725errorloc303 <code> <url>
4726 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 yes | yes | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004731 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004732 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004733
4734 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4735 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4736 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4737 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004738 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739
4740 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4741 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4742 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4743
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004744 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4745
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4747 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4748 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4749 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004750 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004752 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753
4754
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004755email-alert from <emailaddr>
4756 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004757 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | yes
4760
4761 Arguments :
4762
4763 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4764
4765 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4766 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4767
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004768 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004769 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4770 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004771
4772
4773email-alert level <level>
4774 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4775 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4777 yes | yes | yes | yes
4778
4779 Arguments :
4780
4781 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4782 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4783 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4784
4785 By default level is alert
4786
4787 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4788 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4789 for the proxy.
4790
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004791 Alerts are sent when :
4792
4793 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4794 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4795 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4796 is notice or lower
4797 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4798 and a health check status update occurs
4799
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004800 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4801 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004802 section 3.6 about mailers.
4803
4804
4805email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4806 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | yes | yes | yes
4809
4810 Arguments :
4811
4812 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4813
4814 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4815 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4816
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004817 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4818 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004819
4820
4821email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4822 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4823 mailers.
4824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4825 yes | yes | yes | yes
4826
4827 Arguments :
4828
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004829 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004830
4831 By default the systems hostname is used.
4832
4833 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4834 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4835 for the proxy.
4836
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004837 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4838 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004839
4840
4841email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004842 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004843 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 yes | yes | yes | yes
4846
4847 Arguments :
4848
4849 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4850
4851 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4852 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4853
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004854 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004855 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4856
4857
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004858force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4859 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004861 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004862
4863 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4864 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4865 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4866 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4867 marked down for maintenance operations.
4868
4869 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4870 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4871 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4872 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4873 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4874 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4875 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4876 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4877 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4878
4879 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4880 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4881 is used.
4882
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004883 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004884 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004885
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004886
4887filter <name> [param*]
4888 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4890 no | yes | yes | yes
4891 Arguments :
4892 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4893 referenced in section 9.
4894
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004895 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004896 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004897 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4898 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004899
4900 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4901 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4902
4903 Example:
4904 listen
4905 bind *:80
4906
4907 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4908 filter compression
4909 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4910
4911 compression algo gzip
4912 compression offload
4913
4914 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4915
4916 See also : section 9.
4917
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919fullconn <conns>
4920 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | no | yes | yes
4923 Arguments :
4924 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4925 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4926
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004927 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004928 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004929 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4931 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4932 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4933 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4934 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004935 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004936
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004937 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4938 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004939 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4940 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4941 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943 Example :
4944 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4945 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4946 # connections.
4947 backend dynamic
4948 fullconn 10000
4949 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4950 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4951
4952 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4953
4954
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004955grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004956 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004958 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004959 Arguments :
4960 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4961 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4962 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4963
4964 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4965 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004966 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004967 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4968
4969 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4970 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4971 simplify it.
4972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004973
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004974hash-balance-factor <factor>
4975 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | no | no | yes
4978 Arguments :
4979 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4980 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004981 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004982
4983 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4984 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4985 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4986 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4987 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4988 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4989 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4990
4991 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4992 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4993 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4994 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4995 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4996
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004997 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4998 consistent hashing mechanism.
4999
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005000 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5001
5002
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005003hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005004 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | no | yes | yes
5007 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005008 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5009 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005010
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005011 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5012 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5013 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5014 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5015 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5016 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5017 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5018 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5019 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5020 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005021
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005022 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5023 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5024 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5025 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5026 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5027 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5028 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5029 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5030 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5031 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5032 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5033 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5034 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005035 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5036 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005037
5038 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5039
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005040 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005041 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5042 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5043 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005044 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5045 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5046 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005047
5048 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5049 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005050 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5051 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5052 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5053 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5054
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005055 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5056 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5057 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5058 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5059 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5060 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5061 parameter.
5062
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005063 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5064 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5065 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5066 used on strings.
5067
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005068 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5069
5070 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5071 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5072 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5073 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5074 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5075 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5076 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5077 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5078 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5079 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5080 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5081 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005082
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005083 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5084 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5085 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005086
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005087 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005088
5089
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005090http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5091 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5092 ones).
5093
5094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 no | yes | yes | yes
5096
5097 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5098 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5099 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5100 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5101 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5102 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5103
5104 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5105 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5106 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5107
5108 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5109 below.
5110
5111 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5112 instance.
5113
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005114 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5115 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5116 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5117
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005118 Example:
5119 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5120 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5121 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5122
5123http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5124
5125 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5126 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5127 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5128 example, or to pass some internal information.
5129 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5130 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5131 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5132
5133http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5134
5135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5136 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5137
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005138http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005139
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005140 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5141 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5142 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5143 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5144 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005145
5146http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5148
5149 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5150
5151 Example:
5152 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5153
5154 # applied to:
5155 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5156
5157 # outputs:
5158 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5159
5160 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5161
5162http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5163 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5164
5165 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5166
5167 Example:
5168 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5169
5170 # applied to:
5171 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5172
5173 # outputs:
5174 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5175
5176http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5177
5178 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5179 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5180 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5181
5182http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184
5185 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5186 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5187 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5188 fallback.
5189
5190 Example:
5191 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5192 http-response set-status 431
5193 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5194 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5195
5196http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5197
5198 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5199 inline.
5200
5201 Arguments:
5202 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5203 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5206 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5207 (request and response)
5208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5209 processing
5210 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5211 processing
5212 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5213 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5214 and '_'.
5215
5216 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5217 followed by some converters.
5218
5219 Example:
5220 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5221
5222http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5223
5224 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5225 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5226 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5227 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5228 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005229 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005230 processing.
5231
5232 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5233 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005234 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005235 rules evaluation.
5236
5237http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238
5239 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5240 details about <var-name>.
5241
5242 Example:
5243 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5244
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005245
5246http-check comment <string>
5247 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5248 it fails.
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 yes | no | yes | yes
5251
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005252 Arguments :
5253 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5254 rule fails.
5255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005256 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5257 user-friendly error reporting.
5258
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005259 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005260 "http-check expect".
5261
5262
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005263http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5264 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005265 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005266 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 yes | no | yes | yes
5269
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005270 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005271 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5272
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005273 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005274 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005275
5276 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5277 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5278 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5279 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5280
5281 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5282
5283 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5284
5285 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5286
5287 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5288
5289 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5290
5291 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5292 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5293 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5294 is used.
5295
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005296 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5297 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5298 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5299 haproxy -vv.
5300
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005301 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5302
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005303 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5304 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5305 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5306 different ports or with different servers.
5307
5308 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5309 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5310 the port with a "http-check connect".
5311
5312 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5313 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5314 do.
5315
5316 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5317 unset-var or comment rules.
5318
5319 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005320 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5321 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5322 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5323 option httpchk
5324
5325 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005326 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005327 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005328 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005329 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005330 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005331
5332 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5333
5334 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005335
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005337http-check disable-on-404
5338 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005340 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005341 Arguments : none
5342
5343 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5344 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5345 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5346 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5347 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5348 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5349 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5350 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005351 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5352 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005353 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5354 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5355 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005357 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005358
5359
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005360http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5362 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5363 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005364 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005366 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005367
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005368 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005369 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5370
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005371 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5372 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5373 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5374 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5375 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5376 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5377 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5378 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5379 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5380 result is always conclusive.
5381
5382 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5383 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5384 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005385 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5386 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005387 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5388 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005389 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5390 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5391 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392
5393 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5394 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005395 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5396 supported :
5397 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5398 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005399 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5400 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5401 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5402 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5403 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005404
5405 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5406 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005407 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5408 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5409 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5410 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005411 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5412
5413 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5414 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5415 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5416 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5417
5418 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5419 informational message reported in logs if an error
5420 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5421 log-format string.
5422
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005423 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005424 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5425 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005426 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5427 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5428 details on the supported keywords.
5429
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005430 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5431 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5432 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5433 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005434
5435 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5436 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5437 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5438 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5439 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5440
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005441 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5442 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5443 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5444 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5445 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5446 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5447 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005448
5449 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005450 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005451 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5452 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5453 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5454 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5455
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005456 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5457 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005458 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5459 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5460 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5461 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5462 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5463 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5464 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5465 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005466 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5467 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5468 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5469 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5470 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5471 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5472 insensitive on the header names.
5473
5474 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5475 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5476 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5477 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5478 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5479 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005480
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005481 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005482 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005483 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5484 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5485 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5486 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5487 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005488 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005489 trace).
5490
5491 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005492 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005493 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5494 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5495 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5496 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5497 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005498 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005499
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005500 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5501 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5502 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5503 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5504 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5505 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5506
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005507 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005508 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005509 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5510 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5511 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5512 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5513 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5514 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5515
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005516 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5517 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5518 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5519 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5520 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005521
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005522 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5523 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5524
5525 Examples :
5526 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005527 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005528
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005529 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5530 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5531
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005532 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005533 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005534
5535 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005536 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005537
5538 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005539 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005540
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005541 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005542 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005543
5544
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005545http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005546 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5547 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005548 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5549 health checks.
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | no | yes | yes
5552 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005553 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5554
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005555 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5556 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5557 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5558 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5559 to invent non-standard ones.
5560
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005561 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5562 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5563 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5564 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5565
5566 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5567 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5568 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5569 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005570
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005571 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005572 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005573 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005574 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5575 to add it.
5576
5577 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5578 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5579 to the log-format rules.
5580
5581 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5582 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5583 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005584
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005585 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5586 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5587 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5588 request.
5589
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005590 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5591 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5592 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005593 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5594 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5595 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5596 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005597 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005598
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005599 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005600 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5601 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005602
5603 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5604 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5605 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5606 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5607 configured request authority.
5608
5609 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5610 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005611
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005612 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005613
5614
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005615http-check send-state
5616 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 yes | no | yes | yes
5619 Arguments : none
5620
5621 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5622 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5623 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5624 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5625 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5626
5627 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5628 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5629 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5630 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5631 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005632 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5633 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5634 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5635
5636 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5637 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5638 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5639
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005640 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5641 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5642 checked in multiple backends.
5643
5644 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5645 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5646
5647 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5648 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5649 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5650 one fails.
5651
5652 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5653 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5654 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5655
5656 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5657 server's queue.
5658
5659 Example of a header received by the application server :
5660 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5661 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005663 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5664 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005665
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005666
5667http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005668 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | no | yes | yes
5671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005672 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005673 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5674 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5677 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5678 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5679 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5680 and '-'.
5681
5682 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5683
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005684 Examples :
5685 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005686
5687
5688http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005689 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005693 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005694 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5695 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5698 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5700 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5701 and '-'.
5702
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005703 Examples :
5704 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005707http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5708 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5709 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5710 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5711 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | yes | yes | yes
5714 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005715 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005716 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005717 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005718 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005719
5720 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5721 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5722 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5723 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5724
5725 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5726 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5727 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5728 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5729
5730 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5731 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5732 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5733 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5734 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5735 chroot is performed.
5736
5737 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5738 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5739 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5740 considered.
5741
5742 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5743 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5744 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5745 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5746 considered as a raw string.
5747
5748 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5749 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5750 "content-type".
5751
5752 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5753 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5754 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5755 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5756 evaluated as a log-format string.
5757
5758 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5759 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5760 argument to "content-type".
5761
5762 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5763 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5764 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5765 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5766
5767 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5768 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5769 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5770 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5771 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5772 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5773 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5774 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5775
5776 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5777 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5778 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5779
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005780 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5781 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5782 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5783 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5784 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5785
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005786 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5787 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5788
5789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005790http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005791 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5792
5793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5794 no | yes | yes | yes
5795
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005796 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5797 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5798 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5799 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5800 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5803 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005805 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807 Example:
5808 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5809 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5810 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 http-request allow if nagios
5813 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5814 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5815 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817 Example:
5818 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5819 acl add path /addacl
5820 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5825 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005826
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005827 Example:
5828 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5829 acl setmap path /setmap
5830 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005832 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005834 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5835 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5838 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005840http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005842 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5843 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5844 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5845 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5846 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5847 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5848 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5849 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005851http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005853 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5854 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5855 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5856 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5857 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5858 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5859 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5860 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005864 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5865 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005866
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5871 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5872 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5873 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5874 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005875
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005876 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5877 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5878 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5879 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5880 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5881 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5882 instead.
5883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884 Example:
5885 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5886 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005887
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005888http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005889
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005890 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5893 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5896 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5897 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5898 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5899 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5900 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5901 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5902 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5903 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5906 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5907 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005908 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5909
5910 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5911 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5912 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5913 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005917 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5918 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5919 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5920 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5921 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5922 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005923
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005924http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005925
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005926 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5927 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5928 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5929 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5930 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005931
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005932http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005933
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005934 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5935 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5936 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5937 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5938 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5939 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005940
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005941http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5942http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5943 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5944 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5945 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5946 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005947
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005948 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5949 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5950 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005951 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005952 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5953 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5954 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005956 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005957
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005958http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5959 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5960 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5961 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5962
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005963http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5964
5965 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5966 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5967 pointed by <resolvers>.
5968 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5969 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5970 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5971 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5972 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5973 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5974 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5975 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5976 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5977 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5978 to 0.0.0.0.
5979
5980 Example:
5981 resolvers mydns
5982 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5983 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5984 timeout retry 1s
5985 hold valid 10s
5986 hold nx 3s
5987 hold other 3s
5988 hold obsolete 0s
5989 accepted_payload_size 8192
5990
5991 frontend fe
5992 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5993 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5994 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5995
5996 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5997 # which mean DNS resolution error
5998 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5999
6000 default_backend be
6001
6002 backend b_503
6003 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6004 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6005 # 503 error page to end users
6006
6007 backend be
6008 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6009 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6010 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6011 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6012 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6013
6014 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6015 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6016
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006017http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6018
6019 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6020 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6021 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6022 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006023 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6024 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006025
6026 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6027
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006028http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006029http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006030http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006031http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6032http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6033http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006034
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006035 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6036
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006037 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6038 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6039 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6040 processing in your infrastructure.
6041
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006042 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6043 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6044 the supported backend.
6045
6046 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6047 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6048 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6049 number of segments in the path.
6050
6051 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006052
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006053 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component.
6054
6055 Example:
6056 - /. -> /
6057 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6058 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6059 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
6060
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006061 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component.
6062 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
6063 their preceding segment. Empty segments do not receive special treatment.
6064 Use the "path-merge-slashes" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006065
6066 Example:
6067 - /foo/../ -> /
6068 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6069 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6070 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006071 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006072 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
6073
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006074 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6075 removed as well:
6076
6077 Example:
6078 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6079 - /bar/../../ -> /
6080
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006081 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6082 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006083
6084 Example:
6085 - // -> /
6086 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6087
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006088 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006089 (RFC 3986#6.2.21).
6090
6091 Example:
6092 - /%6f -> /%6F
6093 - /%zz -> /%zz
6094
6095 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6096 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6097
6098 Example:
6099 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6100
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006101 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006102 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6103 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6104
6105 Example:
6106 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6107 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6108 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6113 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6114 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6115 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6116 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006118http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006120 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6121 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6122 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6123 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006125http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6126 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006127
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006128 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006129 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6130 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6131 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6132 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6133 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006134
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006135 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6136 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6137 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6138 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6139 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006140
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006141 Example:
6142 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6143
6144 # applied to:
6145 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6146
6147 # outputs:
6148 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6149
6150 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006151
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006152 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6153
6154 # applied to:
6155 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006156
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006157 # outputs:
6158 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006159
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006160http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6161 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6162
6163 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6164 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006165 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6166 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6167 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006168
6169 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6170 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6171 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6172
6173 Example:
6174 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6175 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6176
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006177 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6178 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6179 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6180 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6181
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006182http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6184
6185 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6186 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6187 query-string are replaced.
6188
6189 Example:
6190 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6191 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6192
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006193http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6195
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006196 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6197 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6198 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6199 against.
6200
6201 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6202 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6203 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006204
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006205 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6206 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6207 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6208 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6209 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6210 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6211 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6212 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6213 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006214 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6215 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006216
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006217 Example:
6218 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6219 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006220
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006221 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6222 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006224http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6225 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006226
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006227 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6228 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6229 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6230 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006231
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006232 Example:
6233 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006234
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006235 # applied to:
6236 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006237
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006238 # outputs:
6239 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006240
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006241http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6242 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6243 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006244 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006245 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6246
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006247 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006248 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6249 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006250 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006251 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006252 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006253 are followed to create the response :
6254
6255 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6256 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6257 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6258 ignored.
6259
6260 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6261 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006262 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006263 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6264 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006265
6266 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6267 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6268 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006269 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6270 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006271
6272 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6273 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6274 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006275 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006276 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006277 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006278
6279 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6280 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6281 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6282 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6283 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6284 as a raw content.
6285
6286 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6287 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6288 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6289 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6290 considered as a raw string.
6291
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006292 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006293 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6294 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6295 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6296
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006297 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6298 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006299 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006300
6301 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6302
6303 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006304 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006305 if { path /ping }
6306
6307 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6308 if { path /favicon.ico }
6309
6310 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6311 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6312 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006314http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6315http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006317 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6318 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6319 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006320
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006321http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6322 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006323
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006324 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6325 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6326 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6327 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006329http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006331 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6332 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6333 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6334 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6335 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006337 Arguments:
6338 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6339 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006341 Example:
6342 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6343 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006345 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6346 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006348http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006350 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6351 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6352 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006354 Arguments:
6355 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6356 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358 Example:
6359 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6360 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006362 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6363 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6364 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006366http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6369 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6370 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6371 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6372 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006374 Example:
6375 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6376 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6377 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6378 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6379 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6380 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6381 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6382 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6383 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006385http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006387 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6388 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6389 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6390 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6391 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006393http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6394 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6397 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6398 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6399 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6400 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6401 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6402 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6403 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6404 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006406http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006408 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6409 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6410 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6411 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6412 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6413 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6414 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006416http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006418 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6419 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6420 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006422http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006424 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6425 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6426 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6427 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6428 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6429 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6430 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6431 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006433http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006435 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6436 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6437 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6438 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6439 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6440 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006442 Example :
6443 # prepend the host name before the path
6444 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006445
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006446http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447
6448 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6449 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6450 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006452http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006454 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6455 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6456 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6457 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6458 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006459
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006460http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6463 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6464 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6465 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6466 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6467 values have higher priority.
6468 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6469 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6470 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6471 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6472 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006474http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6477 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6478 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6479 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6480 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6481 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6482 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006484 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006485
6486 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6488 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006490http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6491 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6492 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6493 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006494 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6495 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496
6497 Arguments :
6498 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6499 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006500
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006501 See also "option forwardfor".
6502
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006503 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006504 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6505 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6506
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006507 # After the masking this will track connections
6508 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6509 http-request track-sc0 src
6510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006511 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6512 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6513
6514http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6515
6516 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6517 expression.
6518
6519 Arguments:
6520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6521 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006522
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006523 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006524 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6525 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6526
6527 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6528 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6529 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6530
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006531http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6532 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6533
6534 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6535 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6536 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6537 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6538 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6539
6540 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6541 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6542 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6543 results.
6544
6545 Example:
6546 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6547 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006549http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6550
6551 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6552 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6553 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6554 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6555 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6556 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6557 information from the request.
6558
6559 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6560
6561http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6562
6563 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6564 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6565 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6566 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6567 path and the query string.
6568 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6569
6570http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6571
6572 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6573 inline.
6574
6575 Arguments:
6576 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6577 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6578 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6579 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6580 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6581 (request and response)
6582 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6583 processing
6584 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6585 processing
6586 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6587 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6588 and '_'.
6589
6590 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6591 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006592
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006593 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6597 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6600 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6601 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6602 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6603 agent name must be used.
6604
6605 Arguments:
6606 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6607
6608 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6609 configuration.
6610
6611http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6612
6613 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6614 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6615 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6616 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6617 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6618 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6619 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6620 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6621 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6622 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6623 action.
6624 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6625 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6626 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6627 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6628 you fully understand how it works.
6629
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006630http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6631
6632 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6633 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6634 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6635 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6636 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006637 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006638 processing.
6639
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006640 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006641 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6642 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6643 rules evaluation.
6644
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006645http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6646http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6647 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6648 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6649 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6650 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651
6652 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6653 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6654 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006655 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6656 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6657 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6658 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6659 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6660 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6661 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6662 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6663 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6664 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006665 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006666 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6667 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6668 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6669 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6670 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671
6672http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6673http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6674http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6675
6676 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6677 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6678 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6679 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006680 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6682 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6683 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6684 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6685 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6686 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6687 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6688
6689 Arguments :
6690 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6691 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6692 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6693 select which table entry to update the counters.
6694
6695 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6696 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6697 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6698 that table until the session ends.
6699
6700 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6701 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6702 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6703 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6704 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6705 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6706 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6707 useful information.
6708
6709 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6710 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6711 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6712 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6713 checks that make use of it.
6714
6715http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6716
6717 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006718
6719 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006721
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006722http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6723
6724 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6725 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6726 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6727 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6728 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6729 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6730
6731 Arguments :
6732 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6733
6734 Example:
6735 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6736
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006737http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6738 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6739
6740 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6741 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6742 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6743 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6744 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6745 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6746 http-buffer-request".
6747
6748 Arguments :
6749
6750 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6751 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6752
6753 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
6754 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
6755 bytes.
6756
6757 Example:
6758 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6759
6760 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006764 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6765 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6766 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006767
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006768
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006769http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006770 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6771
6772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 no | yes | yes | yes
6774
6775 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6776 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6777 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6778 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6779 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6780 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006782 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6783 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006785 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006787 Example:
6788 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006790 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006792 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6793 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006795 Example:
6796 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006797
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006798 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006800 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6801 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006803 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6804 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006806http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006808 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6809 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6810 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6811 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6812 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6813 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6814 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6815 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006817http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006819 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6820 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6821 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6822 example, or to pass some internal information.
6823 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6824 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6825 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006827http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006829 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6830 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006831
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006832http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006833
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006834 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006836http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006838 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6839 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6840 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6841 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6842 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6843 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6844 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006846 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6847 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6848 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6849 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6850 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006851
6852 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6853 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6854 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6855 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006857http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006859 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6860 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6861 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6862 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6863 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6864 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006865
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006866http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006867
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006868 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6869 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6870 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6871 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6872 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006874http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006875
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006876 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6877 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6878 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6879 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6880 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6881 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006882
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006883http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6884http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6885 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6886 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6887 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006889
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006890 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6891 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6892 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006893 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006894 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6895 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6896 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006897 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006898 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006900http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006902 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6903 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6904 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6905 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6906 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6907 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006909http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6910 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006911
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006912 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6913 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006915 Example:
6916 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006918 # applied to:
6919 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006921 # outputs:
6922 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006924 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006926http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6927 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006928
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006929 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006930 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006932 Example:
6933 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006935 # applied to:
6936 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006938 # outputs:
6939 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006940
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006941http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6942 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6943 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006944 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006945 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6946
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006947 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006948 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6949 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006950 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006951 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006952 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006953 are followed to create the response :
6954
6955 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6956 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6957 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6958 ignored.
6959
6960 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6961 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006962 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006963 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6964 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006965
6966 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6967 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6968 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006969 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6970 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006971
6972 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6973 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6974 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006975 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006976 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006977 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006978
6979 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6980 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6981 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6982 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6983 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6984 as a raw content.
6985
6986 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6987 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6988 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6989 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6990 considered as a raw string.
6991
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006992 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6993 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6994 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6995 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6996
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006997 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6998 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006999 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007000
7001 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7002
7003 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007004 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007005 if { status eq 404 }
7006
7007 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7008 string "This is the end !" \
7009 if { status eq 500 }
7010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7012http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7015 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7016 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007017
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007018http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7019 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007020
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007021 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7022 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7023 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7024 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007026http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7029 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7030 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7031 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7032 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007034 Arguments:
7035 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007037 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7038 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007042 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7043 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7044 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7047
7048 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7049 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7050 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7051 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7052 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7053
7054http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7055
7056 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7057 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7058 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7059 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7060 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7061 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7062 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7063 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7064 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7065
7066http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7067
7068 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7069 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7070 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7071 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7072 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7073 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7074 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7075
7076http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7077
7078 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7079 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7080 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7081 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7082 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7083 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7084 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7085 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7086
7087http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7089
7090 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7091 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7092 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7093 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007094
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007095 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7097 http-response set-status 431
7098 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7099 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007101http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7104 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7105 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7106 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7107 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7108 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7109 based on some information from the request.
7110
7111 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7112
7113http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7114
7115 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7116 inline.
7117
7118 Arguments:
7119 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7120 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7121 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7122 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7123 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7124 (request and response)
7125 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7126 processing
7127 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7128 processing
7129 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7130 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7131 and '_'.
7132
7133 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7134 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007135
7136 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007137 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007139http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007141 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7142 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7143 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7144 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7145 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7146 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7147 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7148 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7149 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7150 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7151 action.
7152 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7153 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7154 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7155 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7156 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007157
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007158http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7159
7160 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7161 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7162 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7163 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7164 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007165 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007166 processing.
7167
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007168 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007169 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007170 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007171 rules evaluation.
7172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7174http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7175http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007177 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7178 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7179 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7180 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7181 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7182 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7183
7184http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7185
7186 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7187 about <var-name>.
7188
7189 Example:
7190 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7191
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007192http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7193 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7194
7195 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7196 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7197 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7198 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7199 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7200 buffer is full.
7201
7202 Arguments :
7203
7204 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7205 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7206
7207 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
7208 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7209 bytes.
7210
7211 Example:
7212 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007213
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007214http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7215 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7216
7217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7218 yes | no | yes | yes
7219
7220 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007221 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7222 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7223 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007224
7225 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7226
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007227 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7228 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7229 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7230 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7231 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7232 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7233 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7234 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7235 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7236 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007237
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007238 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7239 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7240 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7241 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7242 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7243 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7244 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007245 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7246 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7247 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7248 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7249 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7250 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007251
7252 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7253 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7254 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7255 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7256 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7257 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7258 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7259 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007260 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007261 downsides of rare connection failures.
7262
7263 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7264 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7265 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7266 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7267 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7268 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007269 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007270 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7271 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7272 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7273 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7274 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7275
7276 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007277 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7278 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7279 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7280 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007281
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007282 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7283 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007284
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007285 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007286
7287 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7288 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7289 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7290
7291 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7292
7293
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007294http-send-name-header [<header>]
7295 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007298 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007299 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7300
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007301 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7302 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7303 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7304 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7305 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7306 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7307 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7308 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7309 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7310 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7311 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7312 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7313 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7314 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7315 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7316 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007317
7318 See also : "server"
7319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007320id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007321 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7323 no | yes | yes | yes
7324 Arguments : none
7325
7326 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7327 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7328 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007329
7330
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007331ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7332 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007334 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007335
7336 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7337 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7338 and running).
7339
7340 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7341 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7342 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007343 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007344 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7345
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007346 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7347 "unless" condition is met.
7348
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007349 Example:
7350 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7351 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7352 ignore-persist if url_static
7353
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007354 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7355
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007356load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7357 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 yes | no | yes | yes
7360
7361 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7362 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7363 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007364 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007365 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7366 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7367 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7368 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007370 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007371 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007372 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007373
7374 Arguments:
7375 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7376 named "server-state-file".
7377
7378 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7379 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7380 name is used as a file name.
7381
7382 none don't load any stat for this backend
7383
7384 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007385 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7386 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7387 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007389 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007390
7391 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7392 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7393
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007394 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007395
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007396 global
7397 stats socket /tmp/socket
7398 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007399
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007400 defaults
7401 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007402
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007403 backend bk
7404 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7405 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007406
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007407
7408 Then one can run :
7409
7410 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7411
7412 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7413
7414 1
7415 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7416 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7417 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7418
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007419 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007420
7421 global
7422 stats socket /tmp/socket
7423 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7424
7425 defaults
7426 load-server-state-from-file local
7427
7428 backend bk
7429 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7430 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7431
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007432
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007433 Then one can run :
7434
7435 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7436
7437 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7438
7439 1
7440 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7441 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7442 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7443
7444 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7445 "show servers state"
7446
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007447
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007448log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007449log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007450 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007451no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007452 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007455
7456 Prefix :
7457 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7458 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7459 prefix does not allow arguments.
7460
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007461 Arguments :
7462 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7463 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7464 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7465 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7466 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7467 parameter.
7468
7469 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7470 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7471
7472 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7473 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7474 standard syslog port).
7475
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007476 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7477 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7478 standard syslog port).
7479
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007480 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7481 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7482 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007483 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007484
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007485 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7486 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7487 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7488 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7489 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7490 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7491 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7492 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7493 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7494 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7495 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7496 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7497 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7498 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7499 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7500 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007501 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7502 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007503
7504 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7505 and "fd@2", see above.
7506
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007507 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7508 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7509 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7510 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7511 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7512 having the logs instantly available.
7513
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007514 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7515 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7516 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7517
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007518 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7519 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007520
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007521 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7522 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7523 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7524 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7525 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7526 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7527 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7528 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7529 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7530 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007531 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007532
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007533 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7534 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7535 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7536 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7537 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7538
7539 <sample_size>
7540 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7541 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7542 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7543 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7544 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7545
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007546 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7547 one of the following :
7548
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007549 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7550 field is stripped. This is the default.
7551 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7552 rfc3164.
7553
7554 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007555 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7556
7557 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7558 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7559
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007560 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7561 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7562 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7563 designed to be used with a local log server.
7564
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007565 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7566 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7567 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7568 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7569 systemd logger consumes.
7570
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007571 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7572 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7573 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7574 used with a local log server.
7575
7576 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7577 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7578 designed to be used with a local log server.
7579
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007580 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7581 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7582 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7583 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007585 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7586
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007587 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7588 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7589 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7590
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007591 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7592 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7593 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7594 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007595
7596 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7597 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7598 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007599 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7600 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7601 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7602 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7603 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007604
7605 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7606
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007607 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7608 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7609 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007610
7611 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7612 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7613 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7614 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7615
7616 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7617 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007618
7619 Example :
7620 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007621 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7622 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7623 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007624 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007625 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7626 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007627 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007628
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007629
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007630log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007631 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7632 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007634
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007635 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7636 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7637 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7638 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7639 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007640
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007641 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7642 "option httplog" directives.
7643
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007644log-format-sd <string>
7645 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7647 yes | yes | yes | no
7648
7649 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7650 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7651 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7652 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7653 which covers the log format string in depth.
7654
7655 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7656 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7657
7658 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7659 log format to "rfc5424".
7660
7661 Example :
7662 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7663
7664
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007665log-tag <string>
7666 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7668 yes | yes | yes | yes
7669
7670 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7671 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7672 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7673 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7674 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7675 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7676 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7677 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7678 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007679
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007680max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7681 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7683 yes | no | yes | yes
7684
7685 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7686 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7687 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7688 servers.
7689
7690 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7691 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7692 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7693 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7694 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007695 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007696 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7697 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7698 picking a different server.
7699
7700 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7701 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7702 even if they have to be queued.
7703
7704 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7705 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7706
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007707max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7708 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7709 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7710 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007712maxconn <conns>
7713 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7715 yes | yes | yes | no
7716 Arguments :
7717 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7718 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7719 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7720 closes.
7721
7722 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7723 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7724 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7725 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007726 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7727 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7728 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7729 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007730
7731 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7732 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7733 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7734
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007735 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7736 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007737
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007738 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7739
7740
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007741mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007742 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 yes | yes | yes | yes
7745 Arguments :
7746 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7747 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7748 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7749 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7750
7751 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7752 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7753 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7754 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7755 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7756
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007757 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7758 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7759 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007760
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007761 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007762 defaults http_instances
7763 mode http
7764
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007765
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007766monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007767 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007770 Arguments :
7771 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7772 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007773 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007774 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7775 backend and its backup.
7776
7777 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7778 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7779 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7780 servers in a list of backends.
7781
7782 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7783 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7784 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7785 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7786 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7787 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7788 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007789 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7790 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007791
7792 Example:
7793 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007794 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007795 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7796 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7797 monitor-uri /site_alive
7798 monitor fail if site_dead
7799
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007800 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007801
7802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007803monitor-uri <uri>
7804 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7806 yes | yes | yes | no
7807 Arguments :
7808 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7809 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7810
7811 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7812 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7813 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7814 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7815 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7816 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7817 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7818 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7819
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007820 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007821 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7822 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7823 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7824 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7825 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7826 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007827
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007828 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7829 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7830 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7831 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007833 Example :
7834 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7835 frontend www
7836 mode http
7837 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7838
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007839 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007841
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007842option abortonclose
7843no option abortonclose
7844 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7846 yes | no | yes | yes
7847 Arguments : none
7848
7849 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7850 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7851 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7852 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007853 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007854 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7855 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7856 encountered while delivering the response.
7857
7858 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7859 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7860 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7861 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7862 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7863 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007864 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007865 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007866 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007867 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7868 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7869 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7870
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007871 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7872 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007873 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7874 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7875 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7876 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7877 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7878 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007879 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007880
7881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7883
7884 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7885
7886
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007887option accept-invalid-http-request
7888no option accept-invalid-http-request
7889 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | yes | yes | no
7892 Arguments : none
7893
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007894 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007895 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007896 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007897 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7898 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7899 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7900 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7901 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007902 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7903 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7904 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7905 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007906 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007907 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007908 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7909 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7910 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007911
7912 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7913 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7914 been confirmed.
7915
7916 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7917 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007918 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7919 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007920 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7921
7922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7924
7925 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7926 stats socket.
7927
7928
7929option accept-invalid-http-response
7930no option accept-invalid-http-response
7931 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7933 yes | no | yes | yes
7934 Arguments : none
7935
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007936 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007937 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007938 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007939 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7940 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7941 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7942 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7943 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007944 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7945 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7946 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007947
7948 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7949 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7950 been confirmed.
7951
7952 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7953 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7954 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7955 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7956
7957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7959
7960 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7961 stats socket.
7962
7963
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007964option allbackups
7965no option allbackups
7966 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7968 yes | no | yes | yes
7969 Arguments : none
7970
7971 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7972 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7973 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7974 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7975 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7976 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7977 order between the backup servers anymore.
7978
7979 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7980 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7981
7982 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7983 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7984
7985
7986option checkcache
7987no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007988 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 yes | no | yes | yes
7991 Arguments : none
7992
7993 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7994 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007995 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007996 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7997 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007998 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007999
8000 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008001 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008002 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008003 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8004 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008005 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008006 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008007 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8008 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008009 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008010 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8011 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008012 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008013 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8014 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8015 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8016 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8017 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8018 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8019 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8020 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8021 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8022
8023 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008024 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8025 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8026 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8027 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008028
8029 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8030 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008031 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008032 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008033
8034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8036
8037
8038option clitcpka
8039no option clitcpka
8040 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 yes | yes | yes | no
8043 Arguments : none
8044
8045 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8046 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008047 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008048 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8049
8050 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8051 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8052 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8053 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8054
8055 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8056 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8057 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8058 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8059 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8060
8061 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8062
8063 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8064 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8065 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8066
8067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8069
8070 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8071
8072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008073option contstats
8074 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8076 yes | yes | yes | no
8077 Arguments : none
8078
8079 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8080 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8081 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8082 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008083 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8084 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8085 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8086 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8087 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008088
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008089option disable-h2-upgrade
8090no option disable-h2-upgrade
8091 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8092 connection.
8093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8094 yes | yes | yes | no
8095 Arguments : none
8096
8097 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8098 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8099 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8100 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008101 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8102 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8103 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8104 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8105 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8106 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008107
8108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008110
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008111option dontlog-normal
8112no option dontlog-normal
8113 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 yes | yes | yes | no
8116 Arguments : none
8117
8118 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8119 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8120 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8121 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8122 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8123 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8124 logged.
8125
8126 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8127 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8128 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008130 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008131 logging.
8132
8133
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008134option dontlognull
8135no option dontlognull
8136 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | no
8139 Arguments : none
8140
8141 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8142 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8143 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8144 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8145 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8146 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008147 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8148 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8149 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008150
8151 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008152 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008153 would not be logged.
8154
8155 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8156 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8157
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008158 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008159 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008160
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008161
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008162option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008163 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8165 yes | yes | yes | yes
8166 Arguments :
8167 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8168 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008169 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008170 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008171
8172 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8173 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8174 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8175 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8176 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8177 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8178 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008179 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8180 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8181 possible that the client has already brought one.
8182
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008183 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008184 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008185 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008186 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008187 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008188 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008189
8190 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8191 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8192 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8193 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8194 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8195 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008196 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008197
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008198 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8199 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8200 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8201 are under the control of the end-user.
8202
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008203 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008204 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8205 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008206 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8207 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8208 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008209
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008210 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008211 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8212 frontend www
8213 mode http
8214 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8215
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008216 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8217 backend www
8218 mode http
8219 option forwardfor header X-Client
8220
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008221 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008222 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008223
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008224
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008225option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8226no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8227 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 yes | yes | yes | no
8230 Arguments : none
8231
8232 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8233 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8234 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8235 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8236 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8237 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8238 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8239
8240 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8241 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8242 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8243 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8244 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8245 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8246 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8247 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8248 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8249 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8250
8251 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8252
8253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8255
8256 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8257 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8258
8259
8260option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8261no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8262 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8264 yes | no | yes | yes
8265 Arguments : none
8266
8267 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8268 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8269 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8270 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8271 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8272 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8273 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8274
8275 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8276 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8277 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8278 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8279 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8280 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8281 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8282 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8283 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8284 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8285
8286 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8287
8288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8290
8291 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8292 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8293
8294
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008295option http-buffer-request
8296no option http-buffer-request
8297 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8299 yes | yes | yes | yes
8300 Arguments : none
8301
8302 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8303 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8304 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8305 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8306 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8307 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008308 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8309 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8310 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8311 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008312
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008313 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8314 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008315
8316
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008317option http-ignore-probes
8318no option http-ignore-probes
8319 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8321 yes | yes | yes | no
8322 Arguments : none
8323
8324 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8325 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8326 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8327 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8328 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8329 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8330 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8331 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8332 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8334 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008335 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8336
8337 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8338 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8339 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8340 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8341 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8342 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8343 are often the only way to detect them.
8344
8345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8347
8348 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8349
8350
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008351option http-keep-alive
8352no option http-keep-alive
8353 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8355 yes | yes | yes | yes
8356 Arguments : none
8357
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008358 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8359 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008360 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8361 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008362 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8363 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8364 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008365
8366 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8367 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008368 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8369 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8370 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8371 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8372 situations where this option may be useful :
8373
8374 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008375 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008376
8377 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8378 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8379
8380 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8381 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8382 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8383 request.
8384
8385 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8386 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008387 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8388 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8389 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008390
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008391 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8392 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8393 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8394 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8395 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8396 not set.
8397
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008398 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8399 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8400 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008401
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008402 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008403 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008404 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008405
8406
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008407option http-no-delay
8408no option http-no-delay
8409 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8411 yes | yes | yes | yes
8412 Arguments : none
8413
8414 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8415 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8416 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8417 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8418 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8419 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8420 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8421 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8422 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8423 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8424 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8425 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8426 affected.
8427
8428 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8429 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8430 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8431 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8432 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8433 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8434 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8435 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8436 latency environments.
8437
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008438 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8439
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008440
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008441option http-pretend-keepalive
8442no option http-pretend-keepalive
8443 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008445 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008446 Arguments : none
8447
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008448 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008449 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8450 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8451 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8452 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8453 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8454 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8455 consider the response complete.
8456
8457 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8458 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8459 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8460 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008461 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008462 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8463
8464 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8465 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8466 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8467 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8468 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8469 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8470 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8471
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008472 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8473 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8474 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8475 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8476 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8477 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008478
8479 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8480 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8481
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008482 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008483 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008484
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008485
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008486option http-server-close
8487no option http-server-close
8488 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8490 yes | yes | yes | yes
8491 Arguments : none
8492
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008493 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8494 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8495 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8496 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008497 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8498 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8499 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8500 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8501 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8502 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8503 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8504 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8505 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8506 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8507 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008508
8509 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8510 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8511 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8512 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008513 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8514 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008515
8516 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8517 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008518 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8519 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8520 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008521
8522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8524
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008525 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8526 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008527
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008528option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008529no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008530 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8532 yes | yes | yes | no
8533 Arguments : none
8534
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008535 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008536 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8537 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8538 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8539 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8540 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8541 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8542
8543 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8544 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008545 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8546 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8547 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008548
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008549 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8550 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8551 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8552 front of an existing proxy.
8553
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008554 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8555
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008556 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008557
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008558option httpchk
8559option httpchk <uri>
8560option httpchk <method> <uri>
8561option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008562 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8564 yes | no | yes | yes
8565 Arguments :
8566 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8567 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8568 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8569 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8570 ones.
8571
8572 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8573 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8574 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8575
8576 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8577 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8578 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008579 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008580
8581 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8582 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8583 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8584 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8585 the lack of any response.
8586
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008587 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8588 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8589 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8590 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8591
8592 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8593 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8594 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008595
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008596 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8597 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008598 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008599 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008600 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008601
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008602 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8603 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8604 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8605 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8606
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008607 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008608 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8609 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8610 backend https_relay
8611 mode tcp
8612 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8613 http-check send hdr Host www
8614 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008615
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008616 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8617 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8618 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008619
8620
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008621option httpclose
8622no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008623 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 yes | yes | yes | yes
8626 Arguments : none
8627
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008628 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8629 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8630 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8631 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008632 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008633
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008634 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8635 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008636 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008637 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8638 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008639
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008640 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8641 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8642 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008643
8644 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8645 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008646 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8647 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8648 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008649
8650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8652
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008653 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008654
8655
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008656option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008657 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008659 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008660 Arguments :
8661 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8662 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8663 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008664 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008665 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008666
8667 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8668 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8669 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8670 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8671 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8672 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8673 ports.
8674
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008675 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8676 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008677
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008678 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008680 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008681
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008682
8683option http_proxy
8684no option http_proxy
8685 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8687 yes | yes | yes | yes
8688 Arguments : none
8689
8690 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8691 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8692 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8693 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8694 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8695
8696 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8697 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008698 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8699 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008700
8701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8703
8704 Example :
8705 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8706 backend direct_forward
8707 option httpclose
8708 option http_proxy
8709
8710 See also : "option httpclose"
8711
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008712
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008713option independent-streams
8714no option independent-streams
8715 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8717 yes | yes | yes | yes
8718 Arguments : none
8719
8720 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8721 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8722 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8723 receive data or not.
8724
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008725 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008726 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8727 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8728 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8729 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8730 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8731 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8732 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8733 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8734 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8735 socket buffers.
8736
8737 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8738 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8739 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8740 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8741 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8742
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008743 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008744
8745
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008746option ldap-check
8747 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8749 yes | no | yes | yes
8750 Arguments : none
8751
8752 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8753 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8754 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8755 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8756
8757 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8758 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8759
8760 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8761 configure it.
8762
8763 Example :
8764 option ldap-check
8765
8766 See also : "option httpchk"
8767
8768
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008769option external-check
8770 Use external processes for server health checks
8771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8772 yes | no | yes | yes
8773
8774 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8775 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8776 command".
8777
8778 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8779
8780 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8781
8782
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008783option log-health-checks
8784no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008785 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8787 yes | no | yes | yes
8788 Arguments : none
8789
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008790 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8791 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8792 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008793
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008794 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8795 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8796 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8797 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8798 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008800 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008801 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008802
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008803 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8804 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8805 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008806
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008807
8808option log-separate-errors
8809no option log-separate-errors
8810 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 yes | yes | yes | no
8813 Arguments : none
8814
8815 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8816 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8817 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8818 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8819 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8820 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8821 provides very important information.
8822
8823 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8824 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8825 error logs.
8826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008827 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008828 logging.
8829
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008830
8831option logasap
8832no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008833 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8835 yes | yes | yes | no
8836 Arguments : none
8837
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008838 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8839 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8840 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8841 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8842
8843 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8844 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8845 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8846 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8847 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008848 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008849 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8850 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8851 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8852 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008853 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008854
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008855 Examples :
8856 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8857 mode http
8858 option httplog
8859 option logasap
8860 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8861
8862 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8863 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8864 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8865 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008867 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008868 logging.
8869
8870
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008871option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008872 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8874 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008875 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008876 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8877 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008878 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8879 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008880
8881 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8882 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008883 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008884 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8885 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8886 in the MySQL table, like this :
8887
8888 USE mysql;
8889 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8890 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8891
8892 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008893 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008894 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8895 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8896 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8897 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8898 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8899 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8900 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8901
8902 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8903 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008904
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008905 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008906
8907 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8908 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8909 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8910 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008911 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8912 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008913
8914 See also: "option httpchk"
8915
8916
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008917option nolinger
8918no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008919 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8921 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008922 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008923
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008924 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008925 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8926 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8927 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8928 connections.
8929
8930 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8931 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008932 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8933 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8934 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8935 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8936 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8937 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8938 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8939 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8940 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8941 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8942 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8943 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8944 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008945
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008946 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8947 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8948 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8949 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8950 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008951
8952 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8953 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008954 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008955 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008956 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008957
8958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8960
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008961 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8962 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008963
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008964option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8965 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8967 yes | yes | yes | yes
8968 Arguments :
8969 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8970 matching <network>
8971 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8972 header name.
8973
8974 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8975 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8976 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8977 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8978 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8979 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8980 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8981 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8982 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8983 possible that the client has already brought one.
8984
8985 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8986 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8987 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8988 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8989 header and requires different one.
8990
8991 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8992 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8993 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01008994 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
8995 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
8996 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
8997 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
8998 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008999
9000 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9001 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9002 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9003 both are defined.
9004
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009005 Examples :
9006 # Original Destination address
9007 frontend www
9008 mode http
9009 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9010
9011 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9012 backend www
9013 mode http
9014 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9015
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009016 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009017
9018
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009019option persist
9020no option persist
9021 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9023 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009024 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009025
9026 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9027 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9028 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9029 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9030 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9031 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9032 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9033 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9034 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9035 redirected to another valid server.
9036
9037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9039
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009040 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009041
9042
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009043option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9044 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 yes | no | yes | yes
9047 Arguments :
9048 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9049 PostgreSQL server.
9050
9051 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9052 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9053 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9054 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9055
9056 See also: "option httpchk"
9057
9058
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009059option prefer-last-server
9060no option prefer-last-server
9061 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | no | yes | yes
9064 Arguments : none
9065
9066 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9067 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9068 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9069 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9070 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9071 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9072 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9073 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9074 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009075 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9076 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009077 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9078 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9079 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009080 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9081 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9082 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009083
9084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9086
9087 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9088
9089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009090option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009091option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009092no option redispatch
9093 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9095 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009096 Arguments :
9097 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9098 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9099 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009100 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009101 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009102 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009103 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9104 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9105 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009107
9108 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9109 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9110 be able to access the service anymore.
9111
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009112 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9113 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009114
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009115 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9116 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9117 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9118 following order:
9119
9120 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9121
9122 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9123 list, or
9124
9125 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9126
9127 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9128 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9129
9130 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9131 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9132 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9133 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9134
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009135 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009136 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9137 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9141
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009142 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009143
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009144
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009145option redis-check
9146 Use redis health checks for server testing
9147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9148 yes | no | yes | yes
9149 Arguments : none
9150
9151 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9152 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9153 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9154 find the "+PONG" response message.
9155
9156 Example :
9157 option redis-check
9158
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009159 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009160
9161
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009162option smtpchk
9163option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9164 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9166 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009167 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009168 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009169 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009170 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9171
9172 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9173 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9174 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9175
9176 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9177 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9178 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9179 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9180 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9181 dead server.
9182
9183 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9184 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009185 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009186 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9187
9188 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9189 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9190 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9191 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009192 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009193
9194 Example :
9195 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9196
9197 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009200option socket-stats
9201no option socket-stats
9202
9203 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9205 yes | yes | yes | no
9206
9207 Arguments : none
9208
9209
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009210option splice-auto
9211no option splice-auto
9212 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9214 yes | yes | yes | yes
9215 Arguments : none
9216
9217 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9218 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009219 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009220 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009221 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009222 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9223 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9224 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9225 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9226
9227 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9228 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9229 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9230 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9231 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9232 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9233 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9234 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9235 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9236 keyword.
9237
9238 Example :
9239 option splice-auto
9240
9241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9243
9244 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9245 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9246
9247
9248option splice-request
9249no option splice-request
9250 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9252 yes | yes | yes | yes
9253 Arguments : none
9254
9255 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009256 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009257 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9258 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9259 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9260 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9261
9262 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9263
9264 Example :
9265 option splice-request
9266
9267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9269
9270 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9271 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9272
9273
9274option splice-response
9275no option splice-response
9276 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | yes | yes | yes
9279 Arguments : none
9280
9281 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009282 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009283 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9284 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9285 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9286 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9287
9288 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9289
9290 Example :
9291 option splice-response
9292
9293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9295
9296 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9297 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9298
9299
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009300option spop-check
9301 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9303 no | no | no | yes
9304 Arguments : none
9305
9306 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9307 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9308 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9309 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9310
9311 Example :
9312 option spop-check
9313
9314 See also : "option httpchk"
9315
9316
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009317option srvtcpka
9318no option srvtcpka
9319 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9321 yes | no | yes | yes
9322 Arguments : none
9323
9324 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9325 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009327 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9328
9329 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9330 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9331 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9332 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9333
9334 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9335 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9336 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9337 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9338 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9339
9340 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9341
9342 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9343 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9344 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9345
9346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9348
9349 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9350
9351
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009352option ssl-hello-chk
9353 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | no | yes | yes
9356 Arguments : none
9357
9358 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9359 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9360 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9361 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9362 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9363 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9364 hello message.
9365
9366 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9367 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9368 messages, which is appreciable.
9369
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009370 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9371 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9372 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009373
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009374 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9375
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009376
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009377option tcp-check
9378 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9380 yes | no | yes | yes
9381
9382 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9383 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9384
9385 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9386 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9387 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9388
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009389 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009390 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9391 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9392 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9393 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9394 only.
9395
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009396 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009397 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9398 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9399 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9400 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9401
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009402 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009403 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9404 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009405 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009406 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9407 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9408 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9409 the respective protocols.
9410 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009411 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009413 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009414
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009415 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9416 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9417 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9418 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009419
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009420 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9421 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9422 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009423
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009424
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009425 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009426 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009427 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009428 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009429
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009430 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009431 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009432 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009433
9434 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9435 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009436 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009437 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009438 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009439 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009440 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009441 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009442 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9443 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009444 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009445 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9446 tcp-check expect string +OK
9447
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009448 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009449 (send many headers before analyzing)
9450 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009451 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009452 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9453 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9454 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9455 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009456 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009457
9458
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009459 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009460
9461
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009462option tcp-smart-accept
9463no option tcp-smart-accept
9464 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9466 yes | yes | yes | no
9467 Arguments : none
9468
9469 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9470 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9471 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9472 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9473 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9474 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9475
9476 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9477 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9478 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9479 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9480
9481 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9482 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9483 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009484 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009485
9486 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9487 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9488 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9489
9490 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9491 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9492 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9493
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009494 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9495
9496
9497option tcp-smart-connect
9498no option tcp-smart-connect
9499 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9501 yes | no | yes | yes
9502 Arguments : none
9503
9504 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9505 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9506 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9507 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9508 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9509
9510 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9511 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9512 complex.
9513
9514 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9515 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9516 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9517
9518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9520
9521 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9522
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009523
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009524option tcpka
9525 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9527 yes | yes | yes | yes
9528 Arguments : none
9529
9530 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9531 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009532 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009533 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9534
9535 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9536 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9537 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9538 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9539
9540 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9541 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9542 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9543 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9544 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9545
9546 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9547
9548 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9549 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9550 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9551 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9552 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9553 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9554 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9555 backends.
9556
9557 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9558
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009559
9560option tcplog
9561 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009563 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009564 Arguments : none
9565
9566 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9567 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9568 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9569 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9570 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9571 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9572 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9573 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9574
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009575 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009577 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009578
9579
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009580option transparent
9581no option transparent
9582 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009585 Arguments : none
9586
9587 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9588 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9589 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9590 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9591 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9592 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9593 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9594 appropriate server.
9595
9596 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9597 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9598
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009599 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009600 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009601
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009602
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009603external-check command <command>
9604 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9606 yes | no | yes | yes
9607
9608 Arguments :
9609 <command> is the external command to run
9610
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009611 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9612
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009613 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009614
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009615 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9616 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9617 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9618 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9619 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9620 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009621
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009622 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9623
9624 Environment variables :
9625 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9626 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9627
9628 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9629
9630 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9631
9632 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9633 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9634 for a UNIX socket).
9635
9636 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9637
9638 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9639
9640 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9641
9642 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9643
9644 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9645
9646 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9647 socket).
9648
9649 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9650 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9651
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009652 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009654 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9655 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9656 failed.
9657
9658 Example :
9659 external-check command /bin/true
9660
9661 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9662
9663
9664external-check path <path>
9665 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9667 yes | no | yes | yes
9668
9669 Arguments :
9670 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9671
9672 The default path is "".
9673
9674 Example :
9675 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9676
9677 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9678 "external-check command"
9679
9680
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009681persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009682persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009683 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9685 yes | no | yes | yes
9686 Arguments :
9687 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009688 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9689 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009690
9691 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9692 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009693 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009694 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9695 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9696 forwarded to this server.
9697
9698 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9699 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9700 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009701 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009702 a single "listen" section.
9703
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009704 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9705 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9706 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9707
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009708 Example :
9709 listen tse-farm
9710 bind :3389
9711 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9712 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9713 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9714 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9715 persist rdp-cookie
9716 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009717 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009718 balance rdp-cookie
9719 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9720 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9721
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009722 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9723 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009724
9725
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009726rate-limit sessions <rate>
9727 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9729 yes | yes | yes | no
9730 Arguments :
9731 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9732 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9733
9734 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9735 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9736 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9737 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9738 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9739 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9740
9741 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9742 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9743 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9744 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9745
9746 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9747 listen smtp
9748 mode tcp
9749 bind :25
9750 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009751 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009752
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009753 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9754 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9755 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009756
9757 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9758
9759
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009760redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9761redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9762redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009763 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9765 no | yes | yes | yes
9766
9767 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009768 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009769
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009770 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009771 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009772 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9773 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9774 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009775
9776 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9777 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9778 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9779 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9780 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009781 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9782 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9783 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9784 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009785
9786 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9787 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9788 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9789 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9790 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9791 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009792 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009793 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009794 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9795 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9796 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009797
9798 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009799 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9800 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9801 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009802 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009803 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9804 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9805 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9806 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009807
9808 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009809 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009810
9811 - "drop-query"
9812 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9813 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9814 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9815 with a location-type redirect.
9816
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009817 - "append-slash"
9818 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9819 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9820 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9821 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9822
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009823 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9824 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9825 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9826 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9827 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9828 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9829 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9830
9831 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9832 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9833 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9834 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9835 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9836 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9837 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009838
9839 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9840 acl clear dst_port 80
9841 acl secure dst_port 8080
9842 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009843 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009844 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009845 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9846
9847 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009848 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9849 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9850 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009851 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009852
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009853 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9854 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9855 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9856
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009857 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009858 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009859
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009860 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009861 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9862 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9863 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009865 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009866
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009867
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009868retries <value>
9869 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9871 yes | no | yes | yes
9872 Arguments :
9873 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9874 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9875 default value is 3.
9876
9877 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9878 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9879 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9880
9881 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009882 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9883 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009884
9885 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9886 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9887
9888 See also : "option redispatch"
9889
9890
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009891retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009892 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9893 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9894 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9896 yes | no | yes | yes
9897 Arguments :
9898 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9899 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9900 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9901 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9902
9903 none never retry
9904
9905 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9906 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9907
9908 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9909 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9910 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9911 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9912 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9913 processing the request.
9914
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009915 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9916 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9917 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9918 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9919 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9920 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9921 overflow attack for example).
9922
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009923 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9924 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9925 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9926 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9927 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9928 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9929 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9930 amplify denial of service attacks.
9931
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009932 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9933 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9934 considered to be safe to retry.
9935
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009936 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9937 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9938 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9939 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9940 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009941
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009942 all-retryable-errors
9943 retry request for any error that are considered
9944 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9945 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9946 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9947
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009948 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9949 not cumulative.
9950
9951 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9952 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9953 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9954 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9955
9956 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9957 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9958 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9959 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9960 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9961 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9962 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9963 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9964 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9965 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9966 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9967 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9968
9969 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9970 should not use this directive.
9971
9972 The default is "conn-failure".
9973
9974 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9975
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009976server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009977 Declare a server in a backend
9978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9979 no | no | yes | yes
9980 Arguments :
9981 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009982 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009983 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009984
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009985 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9986 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9987 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9988 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009989 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9990 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9991 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9992 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9993 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009994 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9995 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9996 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9997 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9998 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9999 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10000 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010001 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010002 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10003 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10004 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10005 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10006 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10007 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010008 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10009 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010010 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10011 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010013 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010014 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10015 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10016 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10017 adding this value to the client's port.
10018
10019 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10020 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010021 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010022
10023 Examples :
10024 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10025 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010026 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010027 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10028 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10029 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010030
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010031 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10032 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10033 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10034 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10035 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10036
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010037 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10038 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010039
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010040server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010041 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010042 this backend.
10043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10044 no | no | yes | yes
10045
10046 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10047 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10048 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10049 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10050 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010051
10052 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10053 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10054
10055 global
10056 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10057
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010058 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010059 load-server-state-from-file
10060
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010061 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010062 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010063
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010064server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10065 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10066 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10068 no | no | yes | yes
10069
10070 Arguments:
10071 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10072
10073 <num | range>
10074 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10075 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10076 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10077 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10078
10079 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10080
10081 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10082
10083 <params*>
10084 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10085 keyword.
10086
10087 Examples:
10088 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10089 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10090 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10091
10092 # or
10093 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10094
10095 # would be equivalent to:
10096 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10097 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10098 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10099
10100
10101
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010102source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010103source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010104source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010105 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 yes | no | yes | yes
10108 Arguments :
10109 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10110 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010111
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010112 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010113 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10114 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10115 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10116 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10117 supported prefixes are :
10118 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10119 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10120 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010121 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010122 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10123 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010124
10125 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10126 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010127 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10128 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10129 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010130
10131 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10132 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10133 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10134 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10135 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10136 <addr>.
10137
10138 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10139 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10140 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10141 port.
10142
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010143 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10144 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10145 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10146 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010147 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010148 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10149 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10150 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10151 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10152 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10153 HTTP header.
10154
10155 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10156 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010157 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010158 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10159 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10160 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10161 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10162 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10163 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10164 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10165
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010166 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10167 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10168 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10169 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10170 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10171 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10172
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010173 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10174 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10175 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10176 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10177
10178 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10179 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10180 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10181 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10182 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10183 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10184
10185 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10186 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10187 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10188 there are two methods :
10189
10190 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10191 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10192 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10193 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10194 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10195 of the client ranges may be used.
10196
10197 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10198 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10199 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10200 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10201 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10202 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10203 same session.
10204
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010205 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10206 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10207 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010208 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010209
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010210 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10211
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010212 Examples :
10213 backend private
10214 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10215 source 192.168.1.200
10216
10217 backend transparent_ssl1
10218 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10219 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10220
10221 backend transparent_ssl2
10222 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10223 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10224 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10225
10226 backend transparent_ssl3
10227 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10228 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10229 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10230
10231 backend transparent_smtp
10232 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10233 # with Tproxy version 4.
10234 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10235
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010236 backend transparent_http
10237 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10238 # proxy.
10239 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010241 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010242 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10243
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010244
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010245srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10246 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10247 the connection on the server side.
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10249 yes | no | yes | yes
10250 Arguments :
10251 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10252
10253 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10254 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010255 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10256 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010257
10258 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10259
10260
10261srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10262 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10263 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10264 server side.
10265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10266 yes | no | yes | yes
10267 Arguments :
10268 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10269 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10270 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10271 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10272
10273 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10274 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010275 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10276 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010277
10278 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10279
10280
10281srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10282 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10284 yes | no | yes | yes
10285 Arguments :
10286 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10287 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10288 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10289 document.
10290
10291 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10292 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010293 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10294 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010295
10296 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10297
10298
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010299stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10300 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010302 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010303
10304 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10305 matched.
10306
10307 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10308 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10309
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010310 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10311 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010312 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010313
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010314 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10315 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10316 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10317 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010318
10319 Example :
10320 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10321 backend stats_localhost
10322 stats enable
10323 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10324
10325 Example :
10326 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10327 backend stats_auth
10328 stats enable
10329 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10330 stats admin if TRUE
10331
10332 Example :
10333 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10334 userlist stats-auth
10335 group admin users admin
10336 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10337 group readonly users haproxy
10338 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10339
10340 backend stats_auth
10341 stats enable
10342 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10343 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10344 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10345 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10346
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010347 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10348 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10349 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010350
10351
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010352stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10353 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010355 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356 Arguments :
10357 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10358
10359 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10360
10361 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10362 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10363 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10364 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10365 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10366 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10367
10368 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10369 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10370 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010371 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010372
10373 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10374 report using "stats scope".
10375
10376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10378 unobvious parameters.
10379
10380 Example :
10381 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10382 backend public_www
10383 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10384 stats enable
10385 stats hide-version
10386 stats scope .
10387 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010388 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010389 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10390 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10391
10392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10393 backend private_monitoring
10394 stats enable
10395 stats uri /admin?stats
10396 stats refresh 5s
10397
10398 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10399
10400
10401stats enable
10402 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010404 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010405 Arguments : none
10406
10407 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10408 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10409 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10410 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10411 - stats auth : no authentication
10412 - stats scope : no restriction
10413
10414 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10415 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10416 unobvious parameters.
10417
10418 Example :
10419 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10420 backend public_www
10421 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10422 stats enable
10423 stats hide-version
10424 stats scope .
10425 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010426 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010427 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10428 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10429
10430 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10431 backend private_monitoring
10432 stats enable
10433 stats uri /admin?stats
10434 stats refresh 5s
10435
10436 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10437
10438
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010439stats hide-version
10440 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010442 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010443 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010444
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010445 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10446 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10447 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10448 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10449 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10450 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010452 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10453 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10454 unobvious parameters.
10455
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010456 Example :
10457 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10458 backend public_www
10459 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010460 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010461 stats hide-version
10462 stats scope .
10463 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010464 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010465 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10466 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010467
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010468 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10469 backend private_monitoring
10470 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010471 stats uri /admin?stats
10472 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010473
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010474 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010475
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010476
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010477stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10479 Access control for statistics
10480
10481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10482 no | no | yes | yes
10483
10484 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10485 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10486 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10487 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10488 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10489 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10490
10491 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10492 instance.
10493
10494 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10495 about ACL usage.
10496
10497
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498stats realm <realm>
10499 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010501 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010502 Arguments :
10503 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10504 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10505 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10506
10507 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10508 using a backslash ('\').
10509
10510 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10511 only related to authentication.
10512
10513 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10514 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10515 unobvious parameters.
10516
10517 Example :
10518 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10519 backend public_www
10520 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10521 stats enable
10522 stats hide-version
10523 stats scope .
10524 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010525 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010526 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10527 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10528
10529 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10530 backend private_monitoring
10531 stats enable
10532 stats uri /admin?stats
10533 stats refresh 5s
10534
10535 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10536
10537
10538stats refresh <delay>
10539 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010541 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010542 Arguments :
10543 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10544 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10545 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10546 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10547 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10548 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10549
10550 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10551 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10552 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010553 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010554
10555 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10556 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10557 unobvious parameters.
10558
10559 Example :
10560 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10561 backend public_www
10562 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10563 stats enable
10564 stats hide-version
10565 stats scope .
10566 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010567 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010568 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10569 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10570
10571 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10572 backend private_monitoring
10573 stats enable
10574 stats uri /admin?stats
10575 stats refresh 5s
10576
10577 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10578
10579
10580stats scope { <name> | "." }
10581 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010583 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010584 Arguments :
10585 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10586 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10587 section in which the statement appears.
10588
10589 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10590 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10591 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10592 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10593 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10594 exists.
10595
10596 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10597 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10598 unobvious parameters.
10599
10600 Example :
10601 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10602 backend public_www
10603 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10604 stats enable
10605 stats hide-version
10606 stats scope .
10607 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010609 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10610 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10611
10612 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10613 backend private_monitoring
10614 stats enable
10615 stats uri /admin?stats
10616 stats refresh 5s
10617
10618 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010620
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010621stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010622 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010624 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010625
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010626 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010627 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10628
10629 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10630 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10631
10632 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10633 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010634 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010635
10636 Example :
10637 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10638 backend private_monitoring
10639 stats enable
10640 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10641 stats uri /admin?stats
10642 stats refresh 5s
10643
10644 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10645 global section.
10646
10647
10648stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010649 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10651 yes | yes | yes | yes
10652 Arguments : none
10653
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010654 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010655 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10656 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10657 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10658 - IP (socket, server)
10659 - cookie (backend, server)
10660
10661 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10662 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010663 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010664
10665 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10666
10667
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010668stats show-modules
10669 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10671 yes | yes | yes | yes
10672 Arguments : none
10673
10674 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10675 values as a tooltip.
10676
10677 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10678 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10679 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10680
10681 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10682
10683
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010684stats show-node [ <name> ]
10685 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010688 Arguments:
10689 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10690 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10691
10692 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10693 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010694 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010695
10696 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10697 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10698 unobvious parameters.
10699
10700 Example:
10701 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10702 backend private_monitoring
10703 stats enable
10704 stats show-node Europe-1
10705 stats uri /admin?stats
10706 stats refresh 5s
10707
10708 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10709 section.
10710
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010711
10712stats uri <prefix>
10713 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010715 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010716 Arguments :
10717 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10718 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10719 query string.
10720
10721 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10722 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10723 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10724 possible to reach it in the application.
10725
10726 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010727 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010728 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10729 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10730 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10731 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10732
10733 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10734 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10735 an address or a port to statistics only.
10736
10737 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10738 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10739 unobvious parameters.
10740
10741 Example :
10742 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10743 backend public_www
10744 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10745 stats enable
10746 stats hide-version
10747 stats scope .
10748 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010750 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10751 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10752
10753 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10754 backend private_monitoring
10755 stats enable
10756 stats uri /admin?stats
10757 stats refresh 5s
10758
10759 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10760
10761
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010762stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10763 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010765 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010766
10767 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010768 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010769 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010770 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010771 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10772
10773 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10774 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10775 the "stick-table" statement.
10776
10777 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10778 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10779 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10780 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10781 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10782
10783 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10784 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10785 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10786 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10787 transformation rules.
10788
10789 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10790 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10791 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10792 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10793 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10794 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10795 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10796
10797 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10798 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10799 ACL based conditions.
10800
10801 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10802 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10803 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10804 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10805
10806 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10807 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10808 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10809 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10810
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010811 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10812 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010813 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010814
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010815 Example :
10816 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10817 # last 30 minutes
10818 backend pop
10819 mode tcp
10820 balance roundrobin
10821 stick store-request src
10822 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10823 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10824 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10825
10826 backend smtp
10827 mode tcp
10828 balance roundrobin
10829 stick match src table pop
10830 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10831 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10832
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010833 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010834 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010835
10836
10837stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10838 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10840 no | no | yes | yes
10841
10842 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10843 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10844 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10845 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10846
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010847 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10848 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010849 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010850
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010851 Examples :
10852 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010853 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010854
10855 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10856 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10857 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10858
10859
10860 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10861 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10862 backend http
10863 mode http
10864 balance roundrobin
10865 stick on src table https
10866 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10867 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10868 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10869
10870 backend https
10871 mode tcp
10872 balance roundrobin
10873 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10874 stick on src
10875 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10876 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10877
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010878 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010879
10880
10881stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10882 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10884 no | no | yes | yes
10885
10886 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010887 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010888 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010889 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010890 server is selected.
10891
10892 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10893 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10894 the "stick-table" statement.
10895
10896 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10897 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10898 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10899 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10900 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10901 address.
10902
10903 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10904 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10905 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10906 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10907 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10908 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10909 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10910 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10911 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10912 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10913
10914 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10915 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10916 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10917 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10918 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10919 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10920 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10921
10922 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10923 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10924 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10925 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10926
10927 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10928 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10929 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10930 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10931 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10932 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010933 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10934 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10935 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10936 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10937 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10938 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010939
10940 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10941 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10942 the request.
10943
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010944 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10945 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010947
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010948 Example :
10949 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10950 # last 30 minutes
10951 backend pop
10952 mode tcp
10953 balance roundrobin
10954 stick store-request src
10955 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10956 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10957 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10958
10959 backend smtp
10960 mode tcp
10961 balance roundrobin
10962 stick match src table pop
10963 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10964 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10965
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010966 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010967 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010968
10969
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010970stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010971 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010972 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010973 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010975 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010976
10977 Arguments :
10978 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10979 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10980 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10981 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10982
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010983 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10984 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10985 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10986 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10987
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010988 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10989 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10990 instance.
10991
10992 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10993 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10994 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10995 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10996 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10997 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010998 to 32 characters.
10999
11000 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11001 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11002 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011003 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011004 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11005 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011006
11007 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011008 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11009 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011010 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11011 increase.
11012
11013 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011014 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11015 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11016 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011017
11018 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11019 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11020 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11021 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011022 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011023 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11024 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11025 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11026 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11027 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11028 parameter (see below).
11029
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011030 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11031 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11032 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11033 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11034 soft restart.
11035
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011036 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11037 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011038
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011039 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11040 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11041 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11042 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011043 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011044 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011045 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11046 if not expiration delay is specified.
11047
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011048 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11049 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11050 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11051 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11052 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11053 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11054 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11055 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11056 token.
11057
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011058 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11059 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11060 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11061 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011062 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11063 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11064 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11065 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11066 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11067 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11068 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11069 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11070 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11071 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11072 types and their arguments.
11073
11074 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11075 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11076 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11077 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11078
11079 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11080 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11081 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011082 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011083
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011084 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11085 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11086 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011088 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011089 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011090
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011091 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11092 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11093 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11094 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11095
11096 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11097 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11098 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11099 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11100 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11101 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11102
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011103 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11104 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11105 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11106 they were received.
11107
11108 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11109 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11110 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11111 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11112 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11113
11114 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11115 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11116 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11117 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11118 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11119
11120 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11121 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11122 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11123
11124 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11125 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11126 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11127 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11128 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11129
11130 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11131 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11132 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11133 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11134 the client side.
11135
11136 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11137 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11138 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11139 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11140 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11141 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11142 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11143
11144 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11145 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11146 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11147 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11148 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11149 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011150 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011151
11152 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11153 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11154 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11155 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11156 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11157 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11158
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011159 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11160 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11161 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11162 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11163 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11164
11165 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11166 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11167 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11168 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11169 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11170 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11171
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011172 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011174 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11175 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11176
11177 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11178 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11179 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11180 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11181 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11182 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11183 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11184 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11185 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11186 recommended for better fairness.
11187
11188 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011189 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011190 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11191 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11192
11193 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11194 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11195 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11196 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11197 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11198 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11199 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11200 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11201 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11202 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011203
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011204 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11205 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011206 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11207 reference it.
11208
11209 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11210 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011211 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11212 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11213 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011214
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011215 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11216 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11217 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11218 something that can be ignored.
11219
11220 Example:
11221 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11222 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11223 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11224 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11225
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011226 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011227 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011228
11229
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011230stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011231 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11233 no | no | yes | yes
11234
11235 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011236 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011237 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011238 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011239 server is selected.
11240
11241 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11242 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11243 the "stick-table" statement.
11244
11245 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11246 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11247 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11248 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11249
11250 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11251 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11252 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11253 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11254 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11255 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011256 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011257 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11258 rules.
11259
11260 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11261 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11262 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11263 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11264 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11265 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11266 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11267
11268 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11269 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11270 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11271 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11272
11273 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11274 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11275 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11276 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11277 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11278 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011279 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11280 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11281 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11282 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11283 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11284 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11285 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11286 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11287 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011288
11289 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11290
11291 Example :
11292 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11293 backend https
11294 mode tcp
11295 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011296 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011297 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011298
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011299 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11300 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11301
11302 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11303 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11304 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11305
11306 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11307 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011308
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011309 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11310 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11311 # at offset 44.
11312
11313 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11314 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11315
11316 # Learn on response if server hello.
11317 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011318
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011319 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11320 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11321
11322 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11323 extraction.
11324
11325
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011326tcp-check comment <string>
11327 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11328 it fails.
11329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11330 yes | no | yes | yes
11331
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011332 Arguments :
11333 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11334 rule fails.
11335
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011336 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11337 user-friendly error reporting.
11338
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011339 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11340 "tcp-check expect".
11341
11342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011343tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11344 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011345 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011346 Opens a new connection
11347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011348 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011349
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011350 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011351 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11352
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011353 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011354 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011355
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011356 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011357 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11358 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011359 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011360
11361 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011362
11363 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11364
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011365 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11366
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011367 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11368
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011369 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11370
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011371 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11372 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11373 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11374 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11375
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011376 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11377 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11378 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11379 haproxy -vv.
11380
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011381 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011382
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011383 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11384 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11385 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11386
11387 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11388 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11389 of the sequence.
11390
11391 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11392 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11393 do.
11394
11395 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11396 unset-var or comment rules.
11397
11398 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011399 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11400 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11401 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11402 option tcp-check
11403 tcp-check connect
11404 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11405 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11406 tcp-check send \r\n
11407 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11408 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11409 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11410 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11411 tcp-check send \r\n
11412 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11413 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11414
11415 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11416 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011417 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011418 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11419 tcp-check connect port 143
11420 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11421 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11422
11423 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11424
11425
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011426tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011427 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011428 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011429 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011430 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011432 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011433
11434 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011435 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11436
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011437 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11438 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11439 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11440 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11441 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11442 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11443 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11444 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11445 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11446 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11447
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011448 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011449 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11450 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011451 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11452 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11453 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11454
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011455 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11456 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11457 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011458 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11459 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011460 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11461 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011462 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11463 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011464 By default "L7OK" is used.
11465
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011466 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11467 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011468 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11469 supported :
11470 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11471 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011472 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11473 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11474 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11475 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11476 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011477
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011478 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011479 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011480 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11481 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11482 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11483 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011484 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11485
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011486 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11487 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11488 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11489 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11490
11491 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11492 informational message reported in logs if an error
11493 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11494 log-format string.
11495
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011496 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11497 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11498 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11499 followed by some converters.
11500
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011501 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11502 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11503 with the usual backslash ('\').
11504 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011506 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11507 used upper or lower case.
11508
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011509 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11510
11511 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11512 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11513 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11514 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11515 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11516 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11517 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11518 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11519
11520 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11521 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11522 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11523 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11524 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11525 expression.
11526
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011527 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11528 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11529 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11530 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11531 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11532 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11533
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011534 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11535 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11536 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11537 this exact hexadecimal string.
11538 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11539
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011540 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11541 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11542 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11543 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11544 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11545 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11546 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11547 size.
11548
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011549 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11550 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11551 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11552 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11553 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11554 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11555 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11556 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11557 in a binary string before matching the response's
11558 buffer.
11559
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011560 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011561 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011562 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11563 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11564 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11565 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11566 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11567 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11568 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11569 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11570 the null character.
11571
11572 Examples :
11573 # perform a POP check
11574 option tcp-check
11575 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11576
11577 # perform an IMAP check
11578 option tcp-check
11579 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11580
11581 # look for the redis master server
11582 option tcp-check
11583 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011584 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011585 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11586 tcp-check expect string role:master
11587 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11588 tcp-check expect string +OK
11589
11590
11591 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011592 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011593
11594
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011595tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11596tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11597 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11598 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011600 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011601
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011602 Arguments :
11603 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11604
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011605 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11606 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011607
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011608 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11609 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011610
11611 Examples :
11612 # look for the redis master server
11613 option tcp-check
11614 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11615 tcp-check expect string role:master
11616
11617 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011618 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011619
11620
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011621tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11622tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11623 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11624 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011626 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011627
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011628 Arguments :
11629 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011630
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011631 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11632 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011633
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011634 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11635 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11636 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011637
11638 Examples :
11639 # redis check in binary
11640 option tcp-check
11641 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11642 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11643
11644
11645 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011646 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011647
11648
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011649tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011650 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011652 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011653
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011654 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011655 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11656 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11657 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11658 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11659 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11661 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11662 and '-'.
11663
11664 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11665
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011666 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011667 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11668
11669
11670tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011671 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011673 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011674
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011675 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011676 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11677 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11680 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11681 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11682 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11683 and '-'.
11684
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011685 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011686 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11687
11688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011689tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11690 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11692 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011693 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011694 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11695 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011696
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011697 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011698
11699 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11700 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011701 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11702 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11703 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11704 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11705 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11706 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011707
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011708 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11709 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11710 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11711 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011712
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011713 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011714 - accept :
11715 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11716 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11717 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011719 - reject :
11720 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11721 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11722 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11723 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11724 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11725 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11726 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11727 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11728 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11729 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11730 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011731 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011732
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011733 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11734 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11735 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11736 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11737 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11738 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11739 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11740 hosts.
11741
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011742 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11743 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11744 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11745 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11746 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11747 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11748 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11749 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11750
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011751 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11752 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11753 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11754 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11755 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11756 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11757 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11758 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11759 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011760 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11761 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011762
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011763 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011764 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011765 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11766 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11767 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011768 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011769 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011770 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11771 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11772 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11773 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11774 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11775 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11776 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011778 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011779 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011780 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011781 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011782 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11783 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11784 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011785
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011786 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11787 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11788 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11789 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011790
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011791 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11792 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11793 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11794 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11795 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011796 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11797 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11798 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11799 layer7 information is extracted.
11800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011801 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11802 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11803 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11804 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11805 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011806
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011807 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11808 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11809 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11810 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11811
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011812 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11813 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11814 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11815 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11816
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011817 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11818 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11819 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11820 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11821 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011822
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011823 - set-src <expr> :
11824 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11825 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11826 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011827 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011829 Arguments:
11830 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11831 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011832
11833 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011834 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11835
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011836 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11837 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011838
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011839 - set-src-port <expr> :
11840 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11841 expression.
11842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011843 Arguments:
11844 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11845 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011846
11847 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011848 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11849
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011850 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11851 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11852 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011853
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011854 - set-dst <expr> :
11855 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11856 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11857 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11858 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11859 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11860
11861 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11862 followed by some converters.
11863
11864 Example:
11865
11866 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11867 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11868
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011869 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11870 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11871
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011872 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11873 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11874 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11875 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11876
11877
11878 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11879 followed by some converters.
11880
11881 Example:
11882
11883 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11884
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011885 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11886 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11887 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11888
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011889 - "silent-drop" :
11890 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011891 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011892 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11893 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11894 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11895 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11896 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011897 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11898 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011899 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11900 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011901 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011902 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11903 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11904 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11905 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11906
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011907 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11908 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11909 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011911 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11912 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11913 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011914
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011915 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011916 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011917 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011918
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011919 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11920 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11921 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011923 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011924 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11925 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011926
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011927 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11928
11929 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11930
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011931 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11932
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011933 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011934
11935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011936tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11937 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011939 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011940 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011941 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11942 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011944 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011945
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011946 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011947 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11948 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011949 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
11950 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011952 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11953 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11954 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11955 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011956 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11957 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11958 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11959 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11960 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11961 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011962 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011963 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011964
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011965 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11966 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11967 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11968 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011969
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011970 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011971 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011972 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011973 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11974 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011975 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011976 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011977 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011978 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011979 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011980 - set-dst <expr>
11981 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011982 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011983 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011984 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011985 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011986 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011987 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011989 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11990 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011991 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11992 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011993
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011994 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11995 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11996 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11997 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11998 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11999 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012001 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012002 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12003 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012004
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012005 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12006 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12007 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12008 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12009 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12010 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012012 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012013 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12014 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12015 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12016 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12017 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12018 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12019 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12020 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12021 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12022 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012023
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012024 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012025 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12026 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12027 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012028
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012029 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12030 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12031
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012032 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012033 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12034 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012035
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012036 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12037 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012038 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012039 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12040 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012041 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012042 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012043 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012044 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12045 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012046 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012047 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12048 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012049
12050 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12051 followed by some converters.
12052
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012053 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12054 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12055 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12056 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12057 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12058 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12059 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
12060 warning. These directives will be conditionnaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
12061 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12062 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12063
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012064 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12065
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012066 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12067 <var-name>.
12068
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012069 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12070 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12071 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12072 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12073 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12074
12075 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12076 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12077 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12078 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12079 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12080 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12081 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12082 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12083 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12084 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12085 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12086
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012087 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12088 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12089 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12090 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12091 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12092
12093 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12094
12095 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12096
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012097 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12098 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12099 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12100 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12101 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12102 evaluated.
12103
12104 Example:
12105 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012107 Example:
12108
12109 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012110 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012111
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012112 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012113 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012114 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012115 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12116 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012117 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012118 tcp-request content reject
12119
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012120 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12121 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12122 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12123 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12124 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12125 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12126 ...
12127 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012129 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012130 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12131 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12132 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012133 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012134
12135 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12136 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12137 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012138 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012139 tcp-request content reject
12140
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012141 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012142 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012143 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012144 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012145 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12146 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012147
12148 Example:
12149 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12150 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012151 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012153 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012154 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012155
12156 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012158 # protecting all our sites
12159 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012160 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12161 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012162 ...
12163 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12164
12165 backend http_dynamic
12166 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012167 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012168 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012169 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012170 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012171 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012172 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012174 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012175
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012176 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12177 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012178
12179
12180tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12181 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012183 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012184 Arguments :
12185 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12186 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12187 as explained at the top of this document.
12188
12189 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12190 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12191 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12192 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12193 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12194
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012195 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12196 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12197 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12198 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12199
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012200 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12201 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012202 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012203 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012204 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12205 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12206 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12207 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012208
12209 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12210 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12211 it pass through unaffected.
12212
12213 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12214 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12215 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012216 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012217 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12218 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012219 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12220 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12221 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012222
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012223 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012224 "timeout client".
12225
12226
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012227tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12228 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12230 no | no | yes | yes
12231 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012232 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12233 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012234
12235 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12236
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012238 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12239 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012240 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12241 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012242
12243 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12244
12245 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12246 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12247 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12248 inserted.
12249
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012250 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012251 - accept :
12252 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12253 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12254 the rules evaluation.
12255
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012256 - close :
12257 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12258 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12259 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12260 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12261 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12262 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012263 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012264 protocols.
12265
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012266 - reject :
12267 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12268 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012269 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012270
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012271 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12272 Sets a variable.
12273
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012274 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12275 Unsets a variable.
12276
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012277 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12278 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12279 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12280 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12281
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012282 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12283 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12284 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12285 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12286
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012287 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12288 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12289 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12290 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12291 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012292
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012293 - "silent-drop" :
12294 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012295 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012296 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12297 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12298 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12299 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12300 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012301 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12302 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012303 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12304 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012305 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012306 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12307 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12308 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12309 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12310
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012311 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12312 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12313
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012314 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12315 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12316 for changing the default action to a reject.
12317
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012318 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12319 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12320 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12321 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012322 period.
12323
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012324 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12325 declared inline.
12326
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012327 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12328 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012329 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012330 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12331 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012332 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012333 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012334 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012335 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12336 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012338 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12339 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012340
12341 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12342 followed by some converters.
12343
12344 Example:
12345
12346 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12347
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012348 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12349 <var-name>.
12350
12351 Example:
12352
12353 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12354
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012355 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12356 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12357 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12358 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12359 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12360
12361 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12362
12363 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12364
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012365 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12366
12367 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12368
12369
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012370tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12371 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12373 no | yes | yes | no
12374 Arguments :
12375 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12376 below.
12377
12378 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12379
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012380 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012381 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12382 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12383 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12384 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12385 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12386 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12387 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012388 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012389 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12390 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12391 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12392 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12393 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12394 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12395 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12396 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12397 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12398 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12399 instead.
12400
12401 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12402 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12403 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12404 rules which may be inserted.
12405
12406 Several types of actions are supported :
12407 - accept : the request is accepted
12408 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12409 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12410 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012411 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012412 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012413 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012414 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012415 - silent-drop
12416
12417 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12418 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12419 sections for a complete description.
12420
12421 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12422 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12423 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12424
12425 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12426 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12427 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12428 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12429 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12430
12431 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12432 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12433
12434 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12435 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12436 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12437
12438 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12439 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12440 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12441
12442 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12443 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12444 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12445
12446 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12447 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12448 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12449
12450 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12451
12452 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12453
12454
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012455tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12456 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12458 no | no | yes | yes
12459 Arguments :
12460 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12461 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12462 as explained at the top of this document.
12463
12464 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12465
12466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012467timeout check <timeout>
12468 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12469 established.
12470
12471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12472 yes | no | yes | yes
12473 Arguments:
12474 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12475 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12476 as explained at the top of this document.
12477
12478 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12479 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012480 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012481 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012482 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12483 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12484 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012485
12486 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12487 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12488
12489 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12490 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012491 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012492
12493 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12494 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12495 forget about it.
12496
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012497 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12498 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012499
12500
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012501timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012502 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12504 yes | yes | yes | no
12505 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12508 as explained at the top of this document.
12509
12510 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12511 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12512 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012513 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12514 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12515 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12516 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012517 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12518 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12519 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012520 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012521 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12523 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012524 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12525 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012526
12527 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12528 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12529 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12530 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012531 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012532 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12533
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012534 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012535
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012536 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012538
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012539timeout client-fin <timeout>
12540 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12542 yes | yes | yes | no
12543 Arguments :
12544 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12545 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12546 as explained at the top of this document.
12547
12548 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12549 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12550 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12551 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12552 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12553 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12554 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012555 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12556 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12557 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012558
12559 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12560 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12561 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12562
12563 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12564
12565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012566timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012567 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12569 yes | no | yes | yes
12570 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012571 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012572 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12573 as explained at the top of this document.
12574
12575 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012576 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012577 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012578 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012579 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12580 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012581
12582 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12583 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12584 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12585 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012586 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012587 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12588
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012589 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012591
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012592timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12593 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12595 yes | yes | yes | yes
12596 Arguments :
12597 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12598 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12599 as explained at the top of this document.
12600
12601 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12602 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12603 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12604 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12605 once the request has started to present itself.
12606
12607 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12608 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12609 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12610 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12611 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12612
12613 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12614 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12615 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12616 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12617
12618 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12619 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012620 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012621 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12622 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012623 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012624
12625 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12626 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12627 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12628 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12629
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012630 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12631 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012632 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12633
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012634 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12635
12636
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012637timeout http-request <timeout>
12638 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012640 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012641 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012642 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012643 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12644 as explained at the top of this document.
12645
12646 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12647 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12648 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12649 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12650 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12651 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12652 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012653 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12654 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12655 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12656 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012657 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012658 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12659 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012660
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012661 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12662 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12663 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12664 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12665 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012666 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012667
12668 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12669 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012670 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012671 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12672 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12673
12674 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012675 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12676 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12677 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012678
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012679 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012680 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012681
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012682
12683timeout queue <timeout>
12684 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12686 yes | no | yes | yes
12687 Arguments :
12688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12690 as explained at the top of this document.
12691
12692 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12693 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12694 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12695 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12696 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12697
12698 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12699 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12700 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12701 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12702
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012703 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012704
12705
12706timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012707 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12709 yes | no | yes | yes
12710 Arguments :
12711 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12712 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12713 as explained at the top of this document.
12714
12715 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12716 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12717 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12718 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12719 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12720 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12721 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12722
12723 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12724 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12725 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12726 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12727 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012728 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012729 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12731 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012732 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12733 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012734
12735 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12737 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12738 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012739 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012740 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12741
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012742 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012743
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012744
12745timeout server-fin <timeout>
12746 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12748 yes | no | yes | yes
12749 Arguments :
12750 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12751 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12752 as explained at the top of this document.
12753
12754 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12755 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12756 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12757 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12758 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12759 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12760 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12761 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12762 situations, it should not be needed.
12763
12764 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12765 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12766 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12767
12768 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12769
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012770
12771timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012772 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12774 yes | yes | yes | yes
12775 Arguments :
12776 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12778 as explained at the top of this document.
12779
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012780 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12781 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12782 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012783
12784 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12785 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12786 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12787 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012788 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012789
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012790 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012791
12792
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012793timeout tunnel <timeout>
12794 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12796 yes | no | yes | yes
12797 Arguments :
12798 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12799 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12800 as explained at the top of this document.
12801
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012802 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012803 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12804 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12805 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012806 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12807 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012808 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12809 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12810 specified.
12811
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012812 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12813 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12814 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12815 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12816 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12817 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12818 state.
12819
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012820 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12821 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12822 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12823 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012824 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012825
12826 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12827 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12828 forget about it.
12829
12830 Example :
12831 defaults http
12832 option http-server-close
12833 timeout connect 5s
12834 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012835 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012836 timeout server 30s
12837 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12838
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012839 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012840
12841
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012842transparent (deprecated)
12843 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012845 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012846 Arguments : none
12847
12848 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12849 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12850 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12851 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12852 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12853 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12854 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12855 appropriate server.
12856
12857 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12858
12859 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12860 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12861
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012862 See also: "option transparent"
12863
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012864unique-id-format <string>
12865 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12867 yes | yes | yes | no
12868 Arguments :
12869 <string> is a log-format string.
12870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012871 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12872 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12873 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12874 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012875
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012876 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12877 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12878 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12879 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12880 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12881 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12882 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12883 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012884
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012885 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12886 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012887
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012888 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012889
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012890 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012891
12892 will generate:
12893
12894 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12895
12896 See also: "unique-id-header"
12897
12898unique-id-header <name>
12899 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12901 yes | yes | yes | no
12902 Arguments :
12903 <name> is the name of the header.
12904
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012905 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12906 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012907
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012908 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012909
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012910 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012911 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12912
12913 will generate:
12914
12915 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12916
12917 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012918
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012919use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012920 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12922 no | yes | yes | no
12923 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012924 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12925 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012926
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012927 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12928 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012929
12930 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12931 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12932 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012933 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012934 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012935 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12936 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012937
12938 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12939 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12940 assign the backend.
12941
12942 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12943 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12944 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12945 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12946 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12947 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12948
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012949 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012950 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012951 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12952 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12953 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12954
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012955 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12956 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12957 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12958 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12959 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12960 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12961 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12962 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12963 cannot be forced from the request.
12964
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012965 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012966 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12967 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12968
12969 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12970 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012971
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012972use-fcgi-app <name>
12973 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12975 no | no | yes | yes
12976 Arguments :
12977 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12978
12979 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012980
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012981use-server <server> if <condition>
12982use-server <server> unless <condition>
12983 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12985 no | no | yes | yes
12986 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012987 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12988 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012989
12990 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12991
12992 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12993 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12994 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12995
12996 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12997 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12998 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12999 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13000 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13001 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13002 matches will assign the server.
13003
13004 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13005 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13006 with the next rules until one matches.
13007
13008 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13009 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13010 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13011 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13012
13013 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13014 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13015 stripped.
13016
13017 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13018 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013019 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13020 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13021 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013022
13023 Example :
13024 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13025 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13026 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13027 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013028 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013029 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013030 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013031 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13032 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13033
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013034 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13035 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13036 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13037 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013038 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013039 and we fall back to load balancing.
13040
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013041 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013042
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013043
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130445. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013045--------------------------
13046
13047The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13048depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13049settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13050written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13051described in this section.
13052
13053
130545.1. Bind options
13055-----------------
13056
13057The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13058as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13059no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13060parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13061while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13062provided immediately after the setting name.
13063
13064The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13065
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013066accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13067 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13068 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13069 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13070 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13071 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13072 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13073 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13074 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13075 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013076 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13077 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13078 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013080accept-proxy
13081 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013082 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13083 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013084 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13085 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13086 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13087 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013088 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013089 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13090 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013091 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13092 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013093
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013094allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013095 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013096 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013097 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013098 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13099 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013100
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013101alpn <protocols>
13102 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13103 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13104 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013105 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013106 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013107 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13108 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13109 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13110 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13111 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13112 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13113 preference, like below :
13114
13115 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013116
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013117backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013118 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013119 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13120
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013121curves <curves>
13122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13123 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13124 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13125 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13126 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13127 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13128
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013129ecdhe <named curve>
13130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013131 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13132 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013133
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013134ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13136 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13137 client's certificate.
13138
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013139ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13141 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13142 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13143 error is ignored.
13144
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013145ca-sign-file <cafile>
13146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13147 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13148 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13149 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13150 'generate-certificates' for details.
13151
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013152ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13154 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13155 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13156 'generate-certificates' for details.
13157
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013158ca-verify-file <cafile>
13159 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13160 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13161 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13162 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13163 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013165ciphers <ciphers>
13166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13167 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013168 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013169 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013170 information and recommendations see e.g.
13171 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13172 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13173 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13174
13175ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13177 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13178 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13179 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013180 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13181 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013182
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013183crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13185 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13186 to verify client's certificate.
13187
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013188crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13190 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13191 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13192 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13193 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013194 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13195 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013196
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013197 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13198 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13199
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013200 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13201 are loaded.
13202
13203 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013204 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13205 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13206 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13207 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13208 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13209 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13210 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013211 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013212
13213 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13214 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13215 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13216 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013217 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13218 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013219
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013220 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013222 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013223 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013224 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13225 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013226 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13227 clients).
13228
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013229 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13230 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13231 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13232 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13233 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13234 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13235 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13236 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13237 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13238 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13239 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13240 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13241 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13242
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013243 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13244 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13245 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13246 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13247 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13248
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013249 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13250 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13251 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13252 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013253
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013254 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13255 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13256 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013257
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013258crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013260 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013261 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013262 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013263
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013264crt-list <file>
13265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013266 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13267 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013268
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013269 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13270
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013271 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13272 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13273 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13274 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13275 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013276
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013277 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013278 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13279 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13280 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13281 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13282 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013283 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13284 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13285 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013286
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013287 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13288 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13289 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013290
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013291 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13292
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013293 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13294 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13295 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13296 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13297 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13298 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13299 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13300 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013301
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013302 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013303 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013304 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013305 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013306 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013307 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013308
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013309defer-accept
13310 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13311 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13312 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013314 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13315 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13316 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13317 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13318 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13319 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13320 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13321
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013322expose-fd listeners
13323 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13324 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013325 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13326 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013328
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013329force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013330 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013331 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013332 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013333 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013334
13335force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013336 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013337 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013338 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013339
13340force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013341 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013342 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013343 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013344
13345force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013346 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013347 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013348 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013349
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013350force-tlsv13
13351 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13352 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013353 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013354
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013355generate-certificates
13356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13357 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13358 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13359 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13360 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13361 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13362 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13363 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13364 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13365 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13366 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13367
13368 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13369 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013370 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013371 certificate is used many times.
13372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013373gid <gid>
13374 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13375 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13376 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13377 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13378 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13379
13380group <group>
13381 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13382 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13383 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13384 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13385 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13386
13387id <id>
13388 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13389 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13390 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13391 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13392
13393interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013394 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13395 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13396 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13397 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13398 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13399 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013400 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13401 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13402 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13403 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13404 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13405 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013406
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013407level <level>
13408 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13409 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13410 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013411 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013412 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13413 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13414 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013415 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013416 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013417 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013418 all counters).
13419
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013420severity-output <format>
13421 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13422 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13423 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13424 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13425 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13426 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13427 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13428 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13429 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13430 rfc5424 convention.
13431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013432maxconn <maxconn>
13433 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13434 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13435 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13436 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13437 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13438 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13439 eat all memory.
13440
13441mode <mode>
13442 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13443 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13444 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13445 UNIX sockets.
13446
13447mss <maxseg>
13448 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13449 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13450 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13451 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13452 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13453 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13454 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13455 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13456 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13457 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13458 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13459
13460name <name>
13461 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13462 page.
13463
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013464namespace <name>
13465 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13466 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13467 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13468 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013470nice <nice>
13471 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13472 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13473 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13474 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13475 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13476 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13477 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13478 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13479 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13480 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13481 one for an RDP socket.
13482
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013483no-ca-names
13484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13485 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013486 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013487
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013488no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013490 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013491 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013492 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013493 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13494 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013495
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013496no-tls-tickets
13497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13498 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13499 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013500 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13501 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013502 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13503 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13504 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013505
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013506no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013508 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013509 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013510 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013511 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13512 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013513
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013514no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013516 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013517 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013518 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013519 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13520 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013521
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013522no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013524 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013525 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013526 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013527 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13528 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013529
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013530no-tlsv13
13531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13532 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13533 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13534 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013535 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13536 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013537
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013538npn <protocols>
13539 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13540 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13541 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013542 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013543 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013544 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13545 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13546 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13547 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13548 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013549
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013550prefer-client-ciphers
13551 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13552 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13553 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013554 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13555 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13556 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013557
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013558process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013559 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013560 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013561 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013562 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13563 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13564 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13565 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013566 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013567 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13568 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13569 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13570 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13571 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013572
13573 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13574
13575 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13576 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13577 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13578 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13579 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13580 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13581 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13582 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013583
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013584proto <name>
13585 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13586 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13587 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013588 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13589 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13590
13591 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13592 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13593 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13594 also reported (flag=HTX).
13595
13596 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13597 a bind line :
13598
13599 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13600 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13601 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13602
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013603 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013604 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013605 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013606 h2" on the bind line.
13607
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013608ssl
13609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013610 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013611 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13612 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013613 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13614 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013615
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013616ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13617 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013618 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13619 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13620 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013621 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13622
13623ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013624 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13625 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13626 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13627 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013628
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013629strict-sni
13630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13631 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13632 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13633 See the "crt" option for more information.
13634
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013635tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013636 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013637 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13638 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013639 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013640 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13641 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13642 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13643 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13644 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13645 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13646 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13647
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013648tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013649 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013650 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13651 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13652 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13653 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13654 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13655 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13656 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013657 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13658 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13659 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013660
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013661tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13662 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013663 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13664 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13665 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13666 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13667 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13668 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13669 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13670 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13671 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13672 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013673 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13674 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13675
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013676transparent
13677 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13678 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13679 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13680 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13681 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13682 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13683 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13684 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13685 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13686 so check for support with your vendor.
13687
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013688v4v6
13689 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13690 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13691 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13692 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013693 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013694
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013695v6only
13696 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13697 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13698 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013699 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13700 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013702uid <uid>
13703 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13704 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13705 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13706 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13707 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13708
13709user <user>
13710 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13711 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13712 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13713 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13714 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13715
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013716verify [none|optional|required]
13717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13718 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13719 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13720 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13721 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013722 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13723 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13724 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13725 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013726
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200137275.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013728------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013730The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13731which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13732arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13733settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13734after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13735Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13736address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013738 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013739 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013740
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013741Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13742keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013744The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013745
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013746addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013747 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013748 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13749 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13750 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13751 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13752 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013753
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013754agent-check
13755 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013756 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013757 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13758 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13759 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013760
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013761 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013762 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013763 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13764 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13765 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013767 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13768 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13769 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13770 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13771 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013772
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013773 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013775
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013776 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13777 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13778 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013779
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013780 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13781 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13782 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013783
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013784 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013785 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13786 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13787 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13788 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013789 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013790 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013791
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013792 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13793 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013794
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013795 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13796 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13797 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13798 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13799 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13800 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13801 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13802 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13803 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013804
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013805 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13806 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013807 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13808 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13809 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013810 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013811
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013812 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013813 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013814
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013815agent-send <string>
13816 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13817 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13818 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13819 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13820 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13821
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013822agent-inter <delay>
13823 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13824 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13825
13826 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13827 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13828 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13829 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13830 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13831 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13832 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13833 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13834 of backends use the same servers.
13835
13836 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13837
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013838agent-addr <addr>
13839 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13840
13841 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13842 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13843 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13844 hostname, it will be resolved.
13845
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013846agent-port <port>
13847 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13848
13849 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13850
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013851allow-0rtt
13852 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013853 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13854 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013855
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013856alpn <protocols>
13857 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13858 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13859 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013860 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013861 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13862 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13863 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13864 now obsolete NPN extension.
13865 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13866 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13867
13868 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013870backup
13871 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13872 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13873 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13874 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013875 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13876 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013877
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013878ca-file <cafile>
13879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13880 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13881 server's certificate.
13882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013883check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013884 This option enables health checks on a server:
13885 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13886 considered available.
13887 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13888 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13889 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13890 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13891 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13892 set.
13893 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13894 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13895 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13896 exchanges succeed.
13897
13898 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13899 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13900 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13901 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13902 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013903 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013904 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13905
13906 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13907 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13908
13909 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13910 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13911
13912 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13913 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13914 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13915 available.
13916
13917 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13918 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13919 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13920
13921 Example:
13922 # simple tcp check
13923 backend foo
13924 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13925 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13926 backend foo
13927 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13928 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13929 backend foo
13930 option tcp-check
13931 tcp-check connect
13932 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013933
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013934check-send-proxy
13935 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13936 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13937 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13938 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13939 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13940 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13941 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13942
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013943check-alpn <protocols>
13944 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13945 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13946 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13947
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013948check-proto <name>
13949 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13950 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13951 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013952 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
13953 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13954
13955 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13956 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13957 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13958 also reported (flag=HTX).
13959
13960 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
13961 directive on a server line:
13962
13963 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13964 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13965 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13966 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13967
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013968 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013969 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13970 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13971
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013972check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013973 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013974 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13975 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013976
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013977check-ssl
13978 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13979 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13980 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13981 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013982 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013983 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13984 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013985 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013986 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13987 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013988
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013989check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013990 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013991 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13992 for normal traffic.
13993
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013994ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13996 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13997 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013998 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13999 information and recommendations see e.g.
14000 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14001 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14002 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014003
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014004ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14006 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14007 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14008 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014009 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14010 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14011 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014013cookie <value>
14014 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14015 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14016 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14017 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14018 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14019 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14020 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14021
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014022crl-file <crlfile>
14023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14024 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14025 to verify server's certificate.
14026
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014027crt <cert>
14028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14029 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14030 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14031 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14032 certificate request.
14033
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014034disabled
14035 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14036 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14037 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14038 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14039 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014040 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014041
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014042enabled
14043 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14044 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14045 default value.
14046 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14047 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014049error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014050 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14051 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14052 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014054 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014056fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014057 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14058 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14059 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14060
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014061force-sslv3
14062 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14063 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014064 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014065 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014066
14067force-tlsv10
14068 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014069 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014070 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014071
14072force-tlsv11
14073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014074 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014075 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014076
14077force-tlsv12
14078 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014079 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014080 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014081
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014082force-tlsv13
14083 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14084 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014085 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014087id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014088 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14089 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14090 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014091
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014092init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14093 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14094 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014095 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014096 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14097 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14098 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14099 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14100 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14101 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14102 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14103 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14104 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014105 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014106 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14107 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14108 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14109 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14110 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14111 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014112 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014113
14114 Example:
14115 defaults
14116 # never fail on address resolution
14117 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014119inter <delay>
14120fastinter <delay>
14121downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014122 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14123 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14124 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14125 between checks depending on the server state :
14126
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014127 Server state | Interval used
14128 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14129 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14130 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14131 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14132 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14133 or yet unchecked. |
14134 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14135 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14136 | "inter" otherwise.
14137 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014139 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14140 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14141 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14142 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014143 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14144 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14145 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14146 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14147 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014148
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014149log-proto <logproto>
14150 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14151 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14152 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14153 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014155maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014156 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14157 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014158 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14159 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014160 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14161 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14162 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14163 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14164
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014165 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14166 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14167 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14168 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14169 than 50 concurrent requests.
14170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014171maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014172 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14173 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14174 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14175 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014176 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14177 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14178 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14179 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14180 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14181 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14182 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014184max-reuse <count>
14185 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14186 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14187 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14188 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14189 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14190 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14191 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14192 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014194minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014195 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14196 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14197 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14198 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14199 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14200 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014201 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014202 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014203
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014204namespace <name>
14205 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14206 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14207 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14208 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14209
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014210no-agent-check
14211 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14212 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14213 default value.
14214 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14215 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14216
14217no-backup
14218 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14219 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14220 default value.
14221 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14222 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14223
14224no-check
14225 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14226 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14227 default value.
14228 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14229 "default-server" "check" setting.
14230
14231no-check-ssl
14232 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14233 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14234 default value.
14235 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14236 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14237
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014238no-send-proxy
14239 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14240 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14241 default value.
14242 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14243 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14244
14245no-send-proxy-v2
14246 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14247 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14248 default value.
14249 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14250 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14251
14252no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14253 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14254 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14255 default value.
14256 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14257 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14258
14259no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14260 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14261 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14262 default value.
14263 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14264 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14265
14266no-ssl
14267 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14268 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14269 default value.
14270 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14271 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14272
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014273 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14274 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14275 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14276
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014277no-ssl-reuse
14278 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14279 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14280 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14281 and for paranoid users.
14282
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014283no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014284 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14285 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014286 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014287
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014288 Supported in default-server: No
14289
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014290no-tls-tickets
14291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14292 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14293 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014294 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14295 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014296 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14297 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14298 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014299 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014300
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014301no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014302 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014303 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14304 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014305 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14306 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014307 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014308
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014309 Supported in default-server: No
14310
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014311no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014312 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014313 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14314 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014315 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14316 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014317 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014318
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014319 Supported in default-server: No
14320
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014321no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014322 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014323 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14324 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014325 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14326 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014327 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014328
14329 Supported in default-server: No
14330
14331no-tlsv13
14332 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14333 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14334 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14335 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14336 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014337 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014338
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014339 Supported in default-server: No
14340
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014341no-verifyhost
14342 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14343 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14344 default value.
14345 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14346 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014347
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014348no-tfo
14349 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14350 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14351 default value.
14352 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14353 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14354
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014355non-stick
14356 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14357 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14358 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14359
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014360npn <protocols>
14361 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14362 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14363 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014364 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014365 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14366 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14367 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014369observe <mode>
14370 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14371 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14372 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14373 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14374 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14375 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014376 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014377
14378 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014380on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014381 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14382 Currently, four modes are available:
14383 - fastinter: force fastinter
14384 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14385 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14386 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14387 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14388
14389 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14390
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014391on-marked-down <action>
14392 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14393 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014394 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14395 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14396 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14397 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14398 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14399 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14400 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14401 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014402
14403 Actions are disabled by default
14404
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014405on-marked-up <action>
14406 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14407 Currently one action is available:
14408 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14409 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14410 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14411 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014412 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14413 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014414 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14415 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14416
14417 Actions are disabled by default
14418
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014419pool-low-conn <max>
14420 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14421 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14422 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14423 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14424 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14425 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14426 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14427 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14428 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14429 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014430 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14431 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14432 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14433 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014434
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014435pool-max-conn <max>
14436 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14437 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14438 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14439 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14440 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14441 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14442
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014443pool-purge-delay <delay>
14444 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014445 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014446 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014448port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014449 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014450 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14451 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14452 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14453 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14454 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014455
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014456proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014457 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14458 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14459 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014460 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14461 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14462
14463 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14464 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14465 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14466 also reported (flag=HTX).
14467
14468 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14469 a server line :
14470
14471 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14472 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14473 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14474 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14475
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014476 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014477 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014479redir <prefix>
14480 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14481 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14482 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14483 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14484 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14485 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14486 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14487 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014488 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014489 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014490 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14491 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14492 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14493 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14494
14495 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014497rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014498 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14499 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14500 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14501
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014502resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14503 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14504 server.
14505
14506 Available options:
14507
14508 * allow-dup-ip
14509 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14510 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14511 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14512 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14513 For such case, simply enable this option.
14514 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14515
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014516 * ignore-weight
14517 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14518 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14519 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14520
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014521 * prevent-dup-ip
14522 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14523 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14524 same fqdn.
14525 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14526
14527 Example:
14528 backend b_myapp
14529 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14530 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14531 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14532
14533 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14534 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14535 it
14536 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14537 different address
14538
14539 Default value: not set
14540
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014541resolve-prefer <family>
14542 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14543 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14544 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14545 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14546
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014547 Default value: ipv6
14548
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014549 Example:
14550
14551 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014552
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014553resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014554 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014555 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014556 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014557 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14558 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014559 configured network, another address is selected.
14560
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014561 Example:
14562
14563 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014564
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014565resolvers <id>
14566 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14567 hostname.
14568
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014569 Example:
14570
14571 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014572
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014573 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014574
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014575send-proxy
14576 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14577 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14578 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14579 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014580 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14581 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14582 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14583 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14584 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14585 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14586 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14587 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14588 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14589 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014590 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14591 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014592
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014593send-proxy-v2
14594 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14595 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14596 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14597 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014598 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14599 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14600 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14601 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014602
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014603proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014604 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14605 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14606
14607 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14608 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14609 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14610 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14611 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14612 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14613 connection is supported).
14614 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14615 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14616 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14617 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14618 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14619 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14620 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014621
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014622send-proxy-v2-ssl
14623 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14624 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14625 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14626 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14627 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14628 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14629 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014630 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14631 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014632
14633send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14634 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14635 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14636 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14637 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14638 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14639 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14640 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14641 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014642 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14643 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014645slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014646 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14647 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14648 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14649 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14650 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14651 parameters :
14652
14653 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14654 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14655
14656 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14657 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14658 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14659 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14660
14661 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14662 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14663 seen as failed.
14664
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014665sni <expression>
14666 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14667 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14668 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14669 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014670 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14671 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014672 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014673 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14674 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014675
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014676source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014677source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014678source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014679 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14680 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14681 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14682 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14683
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014684 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14685 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14686 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14687 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14688 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14689 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14690 server.
14691
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014692 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14693 specifying the source address without port(s).
14694
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014695ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014696 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14697 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14698 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14699 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14700 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14701 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014702 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14703 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014704
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014705ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14706 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14707 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14708 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14709
14710ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14711 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14712 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14713 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14714
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014715ssl-reuse
14716 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14717 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14718 default value.
14719 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14720 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14721
14722stick
14723 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14724 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14725 default value.
14726 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14727 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014728
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014729socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014730 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014731 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14732 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14733
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014734tcp-ut <delay>
14735 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14736 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14737 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014738 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014739 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14740 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14741 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14742 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14743 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14744 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14745 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14746 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14747 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14748
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014749tfo
14750 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14751 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14752 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14753 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14754 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014755 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014757track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014758 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14759 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14760 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14761 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014762 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14763
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014764tls-tickets
14765 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14766 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14767 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014768 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14769 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14770 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014771 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014772 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014773
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014774verify [none|required]
14775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014776 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014777 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14778 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014780 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14781 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14782 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14783 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14784 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14785 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14786 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14787 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014788
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014789verifyhost <hostname>
14790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014791 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14792 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14793 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14794 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14795 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14796 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14797 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14798 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014800weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014801 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14802 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14803 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014804 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14805 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14806 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14807 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14808 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14809 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014810
14811
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148125.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14813-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014814
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014815HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14816using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014817configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014818This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14819can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14820workload.
14821This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14822resolution at run time.
14823Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14824carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14825
14826
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148275.3.1. Global overview
14828----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014829
14830As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14831different steps of the process life:
14832
14833 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14834 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14835 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14836
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014837 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14838 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014839
14840A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14841 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14842 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14843 resolution to know this new IP.
14844
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014845When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014846HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014847SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14848from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14849will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14850will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014851
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014852A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014853 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014854 first valid response.
14855
14856 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14857 servers return an error.
14858
14859
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148605.3.2. The resolvers section
14861----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014862
14863This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014864HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14865contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014866
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014867When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14868uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14869is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14870answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14871
14872When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014873used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014874
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014875 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14876 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14877 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014878
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014879 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14880 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014881
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014882 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14883 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14884 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014885
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014886For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14887following scenarios are possible:
14888
14889 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14890 ignored
14891
14892 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14893 applied
14894
14895 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14896 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14897
14898 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14899 retries the query with a new type
14900
14901 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14902 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014903
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014904As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14905a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014906<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014907
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014908
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014909resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014910 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014911
14912A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14913
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014914accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014916 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014917 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14918 by RFC 6891)
14919
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014920 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14921 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14922 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14923 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14924 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14925 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014926
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014927nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
14928 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
14929 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
14930 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
14931 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
14932 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
14933 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
14934 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
14935 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
14936 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014937 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14938
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014939parse-resolv-conf
14940 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14941 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14942 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14943
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014944hold <status> <period>
14945 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14946 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014947 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014948 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014949 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14950 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14951 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14952
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014953 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014954
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014955resolve_retries <nb>
14956 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14957 giving up.
14958 Default value: 3
14959
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014960 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14961 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14962 type.
14963
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014964timeout <event> <time>
14965 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14966 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14967 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014968 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14969 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014970 Default value: 1s
14971 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014972 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014973 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014974 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14975 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14976
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014977 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014978
14979 resolvers mydns
14980 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14981 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014982 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014983 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014984 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014985 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014986 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014987 hold other 30s
14988 hold refused 30s
14989 hold nx 30s
14990 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014991 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014992 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014993
14994
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200149956. Cache
14996---------
14997
14998HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14999(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15000RAM.
15001
15002The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15003this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15004
15005If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15006independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15007when we try to allocate a new one.
15008
15009The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15010
15011It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15012"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15013for more details.
15014
15015When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15016replaced by "<CACHE>".
15017
15018
150196.1. Limitation
15020----------------
15021
15022The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15023
15024- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015025- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15026 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15027 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015028- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15029- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015030- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15031 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15032 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015033- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15034 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015035- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15036 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15037 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015038
15039- If the request is not a GET
15040- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15041- If the request contains an Authorization header
15042
15043
150446.2. Setup
15045-----------
15046
15047To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15048the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15049
15050
150516.2.1. Cache section
15052---------------------
15053
15054cache <name>
15055 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15056 size of cache is mandatory.
15057
15058total-max-size <megabytes>
15059 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15060 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15061
15062max-object-size <bytes>
15063 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15064 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15065 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15066
15067max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015068 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015069 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15070 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15071 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15072 default.
15073
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015074process-vary <on/off>
15075 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015076 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15077 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15078 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015079 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015080
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015081max-secondary-entries <number>
15082 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15083 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15084 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15085
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015086
150876.2.2. Proxy section
15088---------------------
15089
15090http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15091 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15092 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15093 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15094 after this one.
15095
15096http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15097 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15098 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15099 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15100 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15101
15102
15103Example:
15104
15105 backend bck1
15106 mode http
15107
15108 http-request cache-use foobar
15109 http-response cache-store foobar
15110 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15111
15112 cache foobar
15113 total-max-size 4
15114 max-age 240
15115
15116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151177. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15118----------------------------------
15119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015120HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15122The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15123these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15124but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15125data called patterns.
15126
15127
151287.1. ACL basics
15129---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015130
15131The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15132content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15133from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15134simple :
15135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015137 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15139 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15142adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015143
15144In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015147
15148This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15149Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15150and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015151an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15152conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15153as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15154are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015155
15156ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15157'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15158which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15159
15160There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15161performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15164specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15165this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015166methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15167ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168
15169Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15170 - boolean
15171 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15172 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15173 - string
15174 - data block
15175
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015176Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15177converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15178would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15179The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15180which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15181
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015182Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15183keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15184fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15185which are summarized in the table below :
15186
15187 +---------------------+-----------------+
15188 | Sample or converter | Default |
15189 | output type | matching method |
15190 +---------------------+-----------------+
15191 | boolean | bool |
15192 +---------------------+-----------------+
15193 | integer | int |
15194 +---------------------+-----------------+
15195 | ip | ip |
15196 +---------------------+-----------------+
15197 | string | str |
15198 +---------------------+-----------------+
15199 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15200 +---------------------+-----------------+
15201
15202Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15203matching method, see below.
15204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15206 - boolean
15207 - integer or integer range
15208 - IP address / network
15209 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15210 - regular expression
15211 - hex block
15212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015213The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15214
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015215 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15216 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015218 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015219 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015220 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015221 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015223The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15224read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15225if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15226lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15227will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15228beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15229a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15230lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15231exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15232
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015233The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15234parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15235ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15236a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15237check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15238
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015239The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15240socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15241file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15244loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15245
15246 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15247
15248In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15249the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15250case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15251as well.
15252
15253The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15254sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15255do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15256methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15257is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015258obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15260default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15261that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15262string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15263
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015264The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15265By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15266string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15267resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15268server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015269waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015270flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15271function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15274sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15275be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015276
15277 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15278 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15280 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15281 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15282 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015283
15284 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15285 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015287
15288 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015290
15291 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015294 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015295 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15296
15297 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15298 binary or string samples.
15299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15301 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015303 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15304 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15305 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15308 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15311 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15314 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15317 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015318 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15321 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15322 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015323
15324For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15325request, it is possible to do :
15326
15327 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15328
15329In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15330buffer, one would use the following acl :
15331
15332 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15333
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015334On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15335possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15336
15337 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15340criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15341method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15342to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15343criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15344the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015347the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15348For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15351 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15352 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15353 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015354
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015355
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015356The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15357types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15358combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15359brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15360default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362 +-------------------------------------------------+
15363 | Input sample type |
15364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015365 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15367 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15368 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015369 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015371 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015373 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015375 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015376 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015377 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015379 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015381 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015383 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015385 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015387 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015389 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015390 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15391 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15392 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015393
15394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153957.1.1. Matching booleans
15396------------------------
15397
15398In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15399Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15400When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15401that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15402
15403Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15404return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15405"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15406
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154087.1.2. Matching integers
15409------------------------
15410
15411Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15412enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15413to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15414
15415Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15416matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15417lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015418
15419For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15420unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15421representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15422
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015423As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15424two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15425instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15426ranges and operators.
15427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015428For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015429operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15430Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15431of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015433Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015434
15435 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15436 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15437 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15438 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15439 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15440
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015441For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015442
15443 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15444
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015445This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15446
15447 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154507.1.3. Matching strings
15451-----------------------
15452
15453String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15454different forms :
15455
15456 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015457 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458
15459 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015460 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461
15462 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15463 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15464
15465 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15466 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15467
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015468 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15470 matches.
15471
15472 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15473 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15474 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015475
15476String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15477exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15478characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15479string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15480to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015481before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015482
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015483Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15484(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15485Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15486
15487Example:
15488 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15489 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154927.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15493---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015494
15495Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15496they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15497possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15498passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15499the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015500the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15501match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015502
15503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155047.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15505-------------------------------------
15506
15507It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15508not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15509a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15510to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15511digits may be used upper or lower case.
15512
15513Example :
15514 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15515 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15516
15517
155187.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15519---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015520
15521IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15522netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15523within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015524host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015525difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15526at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15527does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15528parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015529
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015530The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15531abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15532
15533 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15534 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15535 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15536 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15537 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15538 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15539 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15540 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15541
15542Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15543192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15544
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015545IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15546Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15547trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15548IPv6 patterns.
15549
15550HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15551following situations :
15552 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15553 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15554 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15555 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15556 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15557 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15558 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15559 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15560 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15561 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563
155647.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15565----------------------------------
15566
15567Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15568combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15569
15570 - AND (implicit)
15571 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15572 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15579indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15582"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15583requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15584is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15585
15586 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015587 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15588 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15589 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590
15591To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15592and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15593
15594 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15595 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15596 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15597 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15598
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015599 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15601 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15602 use_backend www if host_www
15603
15604It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15605expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15606be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15607the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15608
15609 The following rule :
15610
15611 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015612 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613
15614 Can also be written that way :
15615
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015616 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617
15618It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15619to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15620simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15621sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15622good use is the following :
15623
15624 With named ACLs :
15625
15626 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15627 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15628 monitor fail if site_dead
15629
15630 With anonymous ACLs :
15631
15632 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15633
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015634See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15635keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636
15637
156387.3. Fetching samples
15639---------------------
15640
15641Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15642against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15643sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15644ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15645of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15646available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15647
15648This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15649Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15650compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15651deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15652
15653The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15654matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15655method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15656indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15657
15658As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15659when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15660mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15661the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15662ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15663
15664Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15665multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15666when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015667incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15668are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15670all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15671
15672Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15673 - name
15674 - name(arg1)
15675 - name(arg1,arg2)
15676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015677
156787.3.1. Converters
15679-----------------
15680
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015681Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15682of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15683is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15684was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015685has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015686unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15687
15688These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15689sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15690the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015691support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015692
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015693A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15694support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15695supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15696(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15697bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015700
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001570151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15702 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15703 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15704 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15705 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15706 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15707
15708 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015709 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15710 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015711 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15712 frontend http-in
15713 bind *:8081
15714 default_backend servers
15715 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15716 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15717
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015718add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015719 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015720 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015721 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15722 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015723 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015724 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15725 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15726 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15727 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015728 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015729 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015730
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015731aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15732 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15733 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15734 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15735 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15736 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15737 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15738
15739 Example:
15740 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15741 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15742
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015743and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015744 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015745 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015746 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15747 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015754 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015755
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015756b64dec
15757 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15758 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015759 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15760 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015761
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015762base64
15763 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015764 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015765 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15766 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015767
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015768bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015769 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015770 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015771 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015772 presence of a flag).
15773
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015774bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15775 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15776 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015777 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015778
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015779concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15780 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15781 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15782 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15783 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15784 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15785 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15786 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15787 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15788 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15789 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015790 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015791 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015792 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15793 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015794
15795 Example:
15796 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15797 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15798 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015799 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015800 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15801
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015802cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015803 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15804 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015805
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015806crc32([<avalanche>])
15807 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15808 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15809 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15810 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15811 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15812 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15813 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15814 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15815 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15816 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015817 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15818
15819crc32c([<avalanche>])
15820 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15821 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15822 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15823 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15824 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15825 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15826 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15827 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015828
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015829cut_crlf
15830 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15831 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15832 updated.
15833
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015834da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015835 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15836 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15837 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15838 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015839 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015840 configuration language.
15841
15842 Example:
15843 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015844 bind *:8881
15845 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015846 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015847
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015848debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15849 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15850 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15851 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15852 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15853 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15854 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15855 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15856 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15857 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15858 printable sample types.
15859
15860 Example:
15861 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015862
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015863digest(<algorithm>)
15864 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15865 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15866
15867 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15868 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15869
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015870div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015871 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15872 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015873 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015874 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15875 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015876 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015877 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15878 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15879 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15880 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015881 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015882 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015883
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015884djb2([<avalanche>])
15885 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15886 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15887 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15888 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15889 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15890 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15891 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015892 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15893 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015894
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015895even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015896 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015897 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15898
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015899field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15900 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15901 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15902 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15903 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15904 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15905 fields.
15906
15907 Example :
15908 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15909 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15910 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15911 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15912 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015913
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015914fix_is_valid
15915 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15916 Information eXchange):
15917
15918 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15919 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015920 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015921 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015922 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015923 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15924 checksum
15925
15926 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15927 the server can be parsed.
15928
15929 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15930 message, false if not.
15931
15932 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15933
15934 Example:
15935 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15936 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15937
15938fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15939 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15940 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15941 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15942 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015943 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015944 added.
15945
15946 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15947 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15948 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15949 fix_is_valid converter.
15950
15951 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15952
15953 Example:
15954 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15955 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15956 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15957 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15958 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015960hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015961 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015962 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015963 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015964 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015965
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015966hex2i
15967 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015968 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015969
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015970htonl
15971 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15972 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15973 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15974 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15975
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015976hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015977 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15978 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15979 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15980 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15981
15982 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15983 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15984
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015985http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015986 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15987 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015988 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15989 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15990 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15991 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15992 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15993 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15994 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15995 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015997iif(<true>,<false>)
15998 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15999 string otherwise.
16000
16001 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016002 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016003
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016004in_table(<table>)
16005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16007 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016008 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016009 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16010
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016011ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016012 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016013 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016014 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16015 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16016 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16017 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16018 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016019
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016020json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016021 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016022 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016023 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016024 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16025 of errors:
16026 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16027 bytes, ...)
16028 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16029 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16030
16031 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16032 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16033 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16034 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16035 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16036 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016037 - "ascii" : never fails;
16038 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16039 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016040 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016041 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016042 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16043 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16044
16045 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016046 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016047
16048 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016049 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016050 capture request header user-agent len 150
16051 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016052
16053 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16054 GET / HTTP/1.0
16055 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16056
16057 Output log:
16058 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16059
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016060json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16061 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16062 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16063 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16064 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16065
16066 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16067 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16068
16069 Example:
16070 # get a integer value from the request body
16071 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16072 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16073
16074 # get a key with '.' in the name
16075 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16076 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16077
16078 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16079 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16080
16081 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16082 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016084language(<value>[,<default>])
16085 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16086 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16087 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16088 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16089 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16090 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16091 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16092 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16093 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016094 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016095 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16096 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016097
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016098 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016099
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016100 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16101 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016103 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16104 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16105 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16106 use_backend spanish if es
16107 use_backend french if fr
16108 use_backend english if en
16109 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016110
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016111length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016112 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16113 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16114 type. The result is of type integer.
16115
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016116lower
16117 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16118 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16119 type. The result is of type string.
16120
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016121ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16122 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16123 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16124 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16125 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16126 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16127 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16128
16129 Example :
16130
16131 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016132 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016133 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16134
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016135ltrim(<chars>)
16136 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16137 representation of the input sample.
16138
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016139map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16140map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16141map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16142 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16143 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16144 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16145 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16146 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16147 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16148 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16149 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016150
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016151 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16152 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16153 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016154
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016155 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016156 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016157
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016158 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16159 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16160 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16161 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016162 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16163 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016164 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16165 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16166 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16167 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16168 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16169 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16170 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16171 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016172 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16173 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16174 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016175 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16176 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16177 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16178 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16179 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016180
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016181 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16182 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16183 the corresponding match text.
16184
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016185 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16186 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16187 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16188 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16189 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016191 Example :
16192
16193 # this is a comment and is ignored
16194 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16195 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16196 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16197 | | | `---------- value
16198 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16199 | `---------------------------- key
16200 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16201
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016202mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016203 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16204 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016205 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016206 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016207 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016208 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16209 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16210 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16211 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016212 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016213 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016214
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016215mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
16216 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16217 <packettype>.
16218 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16219 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16220 from.
16221 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16222 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16223 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16224
16225 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16226 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16227 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16228 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16229
16230 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16231 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16232 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16233 packets only):
16234 17: Session Expiry Interval
16235 33: Receive Maximum
16236 39: Maximum Packet Size
16237 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16238 25: Request Response Information
16239 23: Request Problem Information
16240 21: Authentication Method
16241 22: Authentication Data
16242 18: Will Delay Interval
16243 1: Payload Format Indicator
16244 2: Message Expiry Interval
16245 3: Content Type
16246 8: Response Topic
16247 9: Correlation Data
16248 Not supported yet:
16249 38: User Property
16250
16251 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16252 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16253 packets only):
16254 17: Session Expiry Interval
16255 33: Receive Maximum
16256 36: Maximum QoS
16257 37: Retain Available
16258 39: Maximum Packet Size
16259 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16260 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16261 31: Reason String
16262 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16263 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16264 42: Shared Subscription Available
16265 19: Server Keep Alive
16266 26: Response Information
16267 28: Server Reference
16268 21: Authentication Method
16269 22: Authentication Data
16270 Not supported yet:
16271 38: User Property
16272
16273 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16274 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16275 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16276 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16277
16278 Example:
16279
16280 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16281 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16282 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16283 if data_in_buffer
16284 # do the same as above
16285 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16286 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16287 if data_in_buffer
16288
16289mqtt_is_valid
16290 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16291
16292 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16293 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16294 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16295 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16296
16297 Example:
16298
16299 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16300 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16301
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016302mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016303 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016304 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16305 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016306 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016307 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016308 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016313 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016314 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016315
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016316nbsrv
16317 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16318 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16319 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16320 map lookup.
16321
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016322neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016323 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16324 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16325 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16326 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016327
16328not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016329 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016330 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016331 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016332 absence of a flag).
16333
16334odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016335 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016336 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16337
16338or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016339 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016340 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016341 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16342 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016343 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016344 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16345 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16347 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016348 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016349 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016350
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016351protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16352 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16353 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16354 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16355 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16356 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16357 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16358 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16359 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16360 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16361 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16362 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16363
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016364regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016365 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16366 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16367 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16368 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16369 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16370 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16371 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16372 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16373 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016374 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16375 of characters with other ones.
16376
16377 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16378 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16379 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16380 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16381 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16382 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016383
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016384 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016385
16386 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16387 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16388 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016389 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016390
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016391 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16392 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16393
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016394 # capture groups and backreferences
16395 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016396 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016397 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16398
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016399capture-req(<id>)
16400 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16401 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16402
16403 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016404 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16405 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016406
16407capture-res(<id>)
16408 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16409 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16410
16411 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016412 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16413 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016414
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016415rtrim(<chars>)
16416 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16417 of the input sample.
16418
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016419sdbm([<avalanche>])
16420 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16421 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16422 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16423 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16424 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16425 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16426 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016427 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16428 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016429
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016430secure_memcmp(<var>)
16431 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16432 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16433 match.
16434
16435 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16436 performed in constant time.
16437
16438 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16439 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16440
16441 Example :
16442
16443 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16444 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16445 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16446 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16447
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016448set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016449 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16450 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16451 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016452 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016453 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16454 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016455 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016456 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16457 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016459 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016460
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016461sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016462 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016463 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16464
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016465sha2([<bits>])
16466 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16467 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16468
16469 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16470 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16471
16472 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16473 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16474
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016475srv_queue
16476 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16477 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16478 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16479 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16480 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16481
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016482strcmp(<var>)
16483 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16484 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16485 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16486 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16487 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16488 shorter).
16489
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016490 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16491 strings in constant time.
16492
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016493 Example :
16494
16495 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16496 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16497 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16498
16499
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016500sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016501 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16502 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016503 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016504 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16505 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016506 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016507 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16508 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016509 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016510 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16511 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016512 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016513 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016514
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016515table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16516 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16517 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16518 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16519 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16520 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16521 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16522
16523
16524table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16525 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16526 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16527 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16528 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16529 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16530 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16531
16532table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016536 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16537 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16538
16539table_conn_cur(<table>)
16540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16542 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16543 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16544 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16545
16546table_conn_rate(<table>)
16547 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16548 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16549 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16550 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16551 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16552
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016553table_gpt0(<table>)
16554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16556 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16557 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16558 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16559
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016560table_gpc0(<table>)
16561 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16562 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16563 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16564 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16565 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16566
16567table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16570 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16571 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16572 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16573 sample fetch keyword.
16574
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016575table_gpc1(<table>)
16576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16579 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16580 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16581
16582table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16586 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16587 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16588 sample fetch keyword.
16589
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016590table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16591 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16592 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016593 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016594 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16595 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16596
16597table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16598 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16599 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16600 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16601 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16602 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16603 keyword.
16604
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016605table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16606 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16607 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16608 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16609 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16610 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16611
16612table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16613 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16614 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16615 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16616 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16617 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16618 keyword.
16619
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016620table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16621 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16622 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016623 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016624 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16625 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16626
16627table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16628 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16629 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16630 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16631 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16632 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16633 keyword.
16634
16635table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16636 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16637 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016638 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016639 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16640 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16641 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16642 keyword.
16643
16644table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16645 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16646 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016647 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016648 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16649 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16650 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16651 keyword.
16652
16653table_server_id(<table>)
16654 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16655 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16656 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16657 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16658 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16659 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16660
16661table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016665 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16666 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16667 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16668 keyword.
16669
16670table_sess_rate(<table>)
16671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16673 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16674 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16675 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16676 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16677 keyword.
16678
16679table_trackers(<table>)
16680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16683 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16684 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16685 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16686 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16687 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16688 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16689 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16690
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016691ub64dec
16692 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16693 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16694 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16695
16696 Example:
16697 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16698 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16699
16700ub64enc
16701 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16702
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016703upper
16704 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16705 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16706 type. The result is of type string.
16707
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016708url_dec([<in_form>])
16709 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16710 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16711 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16712 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16713 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16714 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016715
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016716url_enc([<enc_type>])
16717 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16718 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16719 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16720 optional argument is here for future changes.
16721
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016722ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016723 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016724 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16725 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16726 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016727 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16728 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16729 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16730 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016731 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016732 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16733 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016734
16735 Example:
16736 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16737 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16738
16739 message Point {
16740 int32 latitude = 1;
16741 int32 longitude = 2;
16742 }
16743
16744 message PPoint {
16745 Point point = 59;
16746 }
16747
16748 message Rectangle {
16749 // One corner of the rectangle.
16750 PPoint lo = 48;
16751 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16752 PPoint hi = 49;
16753 }
16754
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016755 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16756 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16757 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016758
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016759 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16760 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016761 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016762 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16763
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016764 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016765
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016766 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016767
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016768 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16769 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16770 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016771
16772 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16773 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16774 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16775
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016776 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16777 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16778 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016779
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016780
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016781unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016782 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16783 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16786 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16787 response),
16788 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16789 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16791 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16792
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016793utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16794 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16795 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16796 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16797 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16798 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16799 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16800
16801 Example :
16802
16803 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016804 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016805 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16806
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016807word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16808 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16809 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16810 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016811 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016812 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16813 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16814
16815 Example :
16816 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16817 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16818 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16819 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16820 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016821 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016822
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016823wt6([<avalanche>])
16824 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16825 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16826 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16827 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16828 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16829 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16830 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016831 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16832 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016834xor(<value>)
16835 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016836 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016837 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016838 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016839 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016840 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16841 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016842 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016843 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16844 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016845 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016846 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016847
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016848xxh3([<seed>])
16849 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16850 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16851 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16852 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16853 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16854 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16855 considered as cryptographically secure.
16856
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016857xxh32([<seed>])
16858 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16859 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16860 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16861 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16862 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16863 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16864 as cryptographically secure.
16865
16866xxh64([<seed>])
16867 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16868 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16869 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16870 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16871 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16872 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16873 as cryptographically secure.
16874
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168767.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877--------------------------------------------
16878
16879A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16880not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16881"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16882The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16883
16884always_false : boolean
16885 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16886 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16887
16888always_true : boolean
16889 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16890 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16891
16892avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016893 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16895 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16896 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16897 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16898 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16899 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16900 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16901 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16902 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16903 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16904 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16905 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16906 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016909 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16910 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16911 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16912 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016913 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16914
16915be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16917 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16918 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16919 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16920 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016921 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16922 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016923
16924 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16925 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16926 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016928be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16929 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16930 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16931 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016932 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16934 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016935
16936 Example :
16937 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16938 backend dynamic
16939 mode http
16940 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16941 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016942
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016943bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016944 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16945 of the string.
16946
16947bool(<bool>) : bool
16948 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16949 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016951connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016953 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016954 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16955 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016956
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016957 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016958 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016959 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16960
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016961 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16962 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016963
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016964 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016965 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016966 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016967 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016968 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016969 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016970 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016971
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016972 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16973 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016975 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016976
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016977cpu_calls : integer
16978 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16979 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16980 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16981 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16982 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16983 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16984
16985cpu_ns_avg : integer
16986 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16987 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16988 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16989 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16990 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16991 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16992 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16993 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16994 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16995 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16996 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16997
16998cpu_ns_tot : integer
16999 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17000 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17001 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17002 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17003 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17004 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17005 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17006 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17007 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17008 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17009 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17010 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17011 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17012
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017013date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017014 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017015
17016 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17017 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17018 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017019 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17020
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017021 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17022 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17023 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17024 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17025 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17026
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017027 Example :
17028
17029 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17030 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017031
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017032 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17033 # millisecond granularity
17034 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17035
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017036date_us : integer
17037 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17038 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17039 from the same timeval structure.
17040
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017041distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17042 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17043 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17044 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17045 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17046 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17047 list of supported tokens.
17048
17049distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17050 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17051 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17052 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17053 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17054 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17055 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17056 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17057 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17058 supported tokens.
17059
17060 Example :
17061 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17062 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17063 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17064 # send large files to the big farm
17065 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17066
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017067env(<name>) : string
17068 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17069 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17070 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17071 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17072 certain way.
17073
17074 Examples :
17075 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17076 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17077
17078 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17079 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17082 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017083 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17084 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17086 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017087 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017088 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17089 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017090
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017091fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17092 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17093 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17094 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17097 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17098 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17099 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17100 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17101 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17102 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17103 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17104 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017105
17106 Example :
17107 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17108 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17109 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17110 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17111 frontend mail
17112 bind :25
17113 mode tcp
17114 maxconn 100
17115 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17116 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17117 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17118 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017119
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017120hostname : string
17121 Returns the system hostname.
17122
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017123int(<integer>) : signed integer
17124 Returns a signed integer.
17125
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017126ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17127 Returns an ipv4.
17128
17129ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17130 Returns an ipv6.
17131
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017132lat_ns_avg : integer
17133 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17134 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17135 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17136 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17137 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17138 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17139 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17140 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17141 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017142 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17143 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17144 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17145 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17146 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17147 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017148
17149lat_ns_tot : integer
17150 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17151 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17152 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17153 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17154 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17155 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17156 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17157 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17158 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017159 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17160 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17161 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17162 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17163 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017164 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17165 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17166 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17167 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17168 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17169 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17170
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017171meth(<method>) : method
17172 Returns a method.
17173
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017174nbproc : integer
17175 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17176 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17177 and debugging purposes.
17178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017179nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17180 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17181 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17182 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017183 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17184 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17185 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017186
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017187prio_class : integer
17188 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17189 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17190 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17191
17192prio_offset : integer
17193 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17194 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17195 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17196 set-priority-offset".
17197
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017198proc : integer
17199 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17200 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17201 debugging purposes.
17202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017203queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017204 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17205 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17206 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017207 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17208 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17209 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17210 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17211 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17212
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017213rand([<range>]) : integer
17214 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17215 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17216 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17217 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17218 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17219
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017220uuid([<version>]) : string
17221 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17222 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17223 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017225srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17226 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17227 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17228 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17229 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17230 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017231 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17232 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17233
17234srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17235 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17236 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17237 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17238 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17239 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17240 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17241 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17242
17243 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17244 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017245
17246srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17247 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17248 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17249 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017250 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017251 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17252 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17253 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17254
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017255srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17256 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17257 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17258 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17259 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17260 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17261 fetch methods.
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17264 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17265 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017266 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17268 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017269 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270 overloading servers).
17271
17272 Example :
17273 # Redirect to a separate back
17274 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17275 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17276 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17277
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017278srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17279 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17280 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17281 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17282
17283srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17284 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17285 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17286 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17287
17288srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17289 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17290 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17291 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17292
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017293stopping : boolean
17294 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17295 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17296 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17297
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017298str(<string>) : string
17299 Returns a string.
17300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17302 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17303 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17304
17305table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17306 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17307 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17308 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17309
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017310thread : integer
17311 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17312 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17313 and debugging purposes.
17314
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017315var(<var-name>) : undefined
17316 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017317 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17318 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017319 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017320 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17321 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017322 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017323 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17324 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017325 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017326 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017327
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173287.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329----------------------------------
17330
17331The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17332closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17333methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17334sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17335TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017336the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17337counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017338"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17339used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17340can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17341Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17342table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17343tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17344currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017346bc_dst : ip
17347 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17348 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17349 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17350 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17351
17352bc_dst_port : integer
17353 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17354 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17355
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017356bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017357 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17358 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17359 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17360
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017361bc_src : ip
17362 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17363 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17364 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17365 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17366
17367bc_src_port : integer
17368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17369 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371be_id : integer
17372 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017373 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17374 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017376be_name : string
17377 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017378 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17379 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017380
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017381be_server_timeout : integer
17382 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17383 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17384 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17385
17386be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17387 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17388 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17389 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17390
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017391cur_server_timeout : integer
17392 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17393 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17394 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17395
17396cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17397 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17398 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17399 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401dst : ip
17402 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17403 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17404 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17405 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017406 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17407 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17408 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17409 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17410 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17411 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017412
17413dst_conn : integer
17414 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17415 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17416 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17417 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17418 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17419 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17420 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17421 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017422
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017423dst_is_local : boolean
17424 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17425 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17426 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17427 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017428 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017429 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17430 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17431 it only once per connection.
17432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433dst_port : integer
17434 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17435 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17436 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17437 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17438 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17439 an HTTP header.
17440
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017441fc_http_major : integer
17442 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17443 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17444 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17445
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017446fc_pp_authority : string
17447 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17448 if any.
17449
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017450fc_pp_unique_id : string
17451 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17452 if any.
17453
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017454fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17455 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17456 header.
17457
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017458fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17459 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17460 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17461 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17462 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17463 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17464 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17465
17466fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17467 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17468 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17469 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17470 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17471 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17472 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17473
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017474fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017475 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17476 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17477 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17478 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17479
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017480fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017481 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17482 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17483 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17484 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17485
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017486fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017487 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17488 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17489 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17490 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17491
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017492fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017493 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17494 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17495 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17496 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17497
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017498fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017499 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17500 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17501 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17502 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17503
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017504fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017505 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17506 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17507 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17508 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17509
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017510fe_defbe : string
17511 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17512 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514fe_id : integer
17515 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017516 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17518
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017519fe_name : string
17520 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17521 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17522 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17523
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017524fe_client_timeout : integer
17525 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17526 current frontend.
17527
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017528sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017529sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17530sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17531sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017532 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17533 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17534 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17535
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017536sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017537sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17538sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17539sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017540 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17541 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17542 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017544sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017545sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17546sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17547sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017548 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17549 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017550 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17551 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17552 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017553
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017554 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017555 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17556 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017557 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17558 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17559 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017560 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17561 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17562
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017563sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17564sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17565sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17566sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17567 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17568 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17569 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17570 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17571 when a first ACL was verified.
17572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017573sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017574sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17575sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17576sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017577 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017578 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17579
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017580sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017581sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17582sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17583sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017584 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17585 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17586 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17587
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017588sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017589sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17590sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17591sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017592 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17593 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17594 See also src_conn_rate.
17595
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017596sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017597sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17598sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17599sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017600 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017601 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017602
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017603sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17604sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17605sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17606sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17607 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17608 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17609
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017610sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17611sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17612sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17613sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17614 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17615 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17616
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017617sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017618sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17619sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17620sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017621 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17622 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17623 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017624 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17625 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17626 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017627
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017628sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17629sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17630sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17631sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17632 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17633 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17634 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17635 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17636 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17637 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017639sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017640sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17641sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17642sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017643 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017644 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17645 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17646
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017647sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017648sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17649sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17650sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017651 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17652 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17653 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17654 src_http_err_rate.
17655
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017656sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17657sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17658sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17659sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17660 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17661 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17662 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17663
17664sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17665sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17666sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17667sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17668 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17669 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17670 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17671 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017673sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017674sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17675sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17676sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017677 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017678 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17679 src_http_req_cnt.
17680
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017681sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017682sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17683sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17684sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017685 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17686 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17687 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17688 src_http_req_rate.
17689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017690sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017691sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17692sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17693sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017694 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017695 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17696 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17697 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17698 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017699
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017700 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017701 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17702 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017703 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17704
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017705sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17706sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17707sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17708sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17709 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17710 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17711 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17712 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17713 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017715sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017716sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17717sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17718sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017719 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17720 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17721 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017722
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017723sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017724sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17725sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17726sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017727 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17728 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17729 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017730
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017731sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017732sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17733sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17734sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017735 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017736 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17737 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17738 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017739 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017740 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17741
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017742sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017743sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17744sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17745sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017746 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17747 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17748 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17749 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17750 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017751 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017752
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017753sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017754sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17755sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17756sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017757 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17758 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17759 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17760
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017761sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017762sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17763sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17764sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017765 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17766 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017767 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017768 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17769 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017770 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17771 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17772 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017774so_id : integer
17775 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17776 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17777 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017778
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017779so_name : string
17780 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17781 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17782 strings instead of integers.
17783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017785 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17787 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17788 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017789 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17790 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17791 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017792 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17793 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17794 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17795 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17796 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17797 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17798 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017799
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017800 Example:
17801 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17802 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017804src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17805 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17806 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17807 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017808 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17811 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17812 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017813 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017814 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17817 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17818 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17819 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17820 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17821 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17822 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017823
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017824 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017825 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17826 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17827 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17828 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017829 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017830 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17831 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17832
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017833src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17834 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17835 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17836 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17837 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17838 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17839 was verified.
17840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017842 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017843 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017844 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017845 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017848 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17850 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017851 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017853src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17854 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17855 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17856 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017857 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017860 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017862 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017863 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017864
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017865src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17866 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17867 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17868 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17869 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17870
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017871src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17872 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17873 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17874 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17875 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017877src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017878 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017880 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17881 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017882 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17883 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17884 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017885
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017886src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17887 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17888 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17889 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17890 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17891 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17892 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17893 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017895src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017896 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017898 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017899 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17903 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17904 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17905 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17906 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017907 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017908
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017909src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17910 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17911 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017912 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017913 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17914 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17915
17916src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17917 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17918 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17919 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17920 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17921 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17922 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017924src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017925 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017926 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17927 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017928 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017930src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17931 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17932 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17933 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017934 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017935 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17938 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17939 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17940 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017941 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17943 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017944
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017945 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017946 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017947 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017948 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017949
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017950src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17951 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17952 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17953 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17954 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17955 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17956 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17957
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017958src_is_local : boolean
17959 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17960 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17961 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17962 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017963 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017964 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17965 once per connection.
17966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017967src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017968 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17969 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17970 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17971 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17972 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017975 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17976 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17977 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17978 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17979 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981src_port : integer
17982 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17983 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17984 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17985 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017987src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017988 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017989 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17990 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17991 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017992 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17995 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17996 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17997 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17998 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017999 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18002 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18003 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18004 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18005 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18006 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18007 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18008 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18009 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018010
18011 Example :
18012 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18013 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18014 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18015 listen ssh
18016 bind :22
18017 mode tcp
18018 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018019 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018021 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023srv_id : integer
18024 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18025 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018026 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018027
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018028srv_name : string
18029 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18030 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018031 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018032
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180337.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018034----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018036The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18037closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18038when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18039usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018040future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018041
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001804251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18043 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18044 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18045 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18046 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18047 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18048
18049 Example :
18050 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18051 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18052 # the request.
18053 frontend http-in
18054 bind *:8081
18055 default_backend servers
18056 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18057 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18058
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018059ssl_bc : boolean
18060 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18061 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018062 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18063 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018064
18065ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18066 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018067 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18068 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018069
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018070ssl_bc_alpn : string
18071 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18072 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018073 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018074 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18075 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18076 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18077 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18078 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018079 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18080 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018081
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018082ssl_bc_cipher : string
18083 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018084 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18085 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018086
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018087ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18088 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18089 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18090 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018091 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018092
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018093ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18094 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18095 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018096 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18097 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018098
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018099ssl_bc_npn : string
18100 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18101 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018102 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018103 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18104 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18105 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18106 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018107 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18108 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018109
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018110ssl_bc_protocol : string
18111 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018112 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18113 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018114
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018115ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018116 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018117 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018118 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18119 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018120
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018121ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18122 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18123 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18124 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018125 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018126
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018127ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18128 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18129 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018130 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18131 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018132
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018133ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18134 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18135 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18136 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018137 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018138
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018139ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18140 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018141 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18142 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018144ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18145 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18146 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18147 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18148 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18149 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018151ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18152 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18153 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18154 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18155 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018156
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018157ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018158 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18159 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18160 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018161 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018162 does not support resumed sessions.
18163
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018164ssl_c_der : binary
18165 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18166 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18167 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018169ssl_c_err : integer
18170 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18171 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18172 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18173 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18174 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018175
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018176ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18178 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18179 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18180 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18181 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18182 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18183 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18184 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018185 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18186 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18187 LDAP v3.
18188 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18189 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018191ssl_c_key_alg : string
18192 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18193 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18194 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196ssl_c_notafter : string
18197 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18198 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18199 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201ssl_c_notbefore : string
18202 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18203 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18204 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018205
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018206ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018207 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18208 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18209 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18210 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18211 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18212 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18213 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18214 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018215 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18216 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18217 LDAP v3.
18218 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18219 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018221ssl_c_serial : binary
18222 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18223 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18224 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018226ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18227 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18228 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18229 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018230 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18231 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18232
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018233 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018234 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18237 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18238 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18239 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241ssl_c_used : boolean
18242 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18243 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245ssl_c_verify : integer
18246 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18247 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18248 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18249 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251ssl_c_version : integer
18252 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18253 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018254
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018255ssl_f_der : binary
18256 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18257 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18258 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18259
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018260ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018261 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18262 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18263 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18264 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018265 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018266 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18267 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18268 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018269 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18270 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18271 LDAP v3.
18272 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18273 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018275ssl_f_key_alg : string
18276 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18277 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18278 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280ssl_f_notafter : string
18281 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18282 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18283 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285ssl_f_notbefore : string
18286 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18287 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18288 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018289
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018290ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018291 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18292 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18293 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18294 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18295 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18296 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18297 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18298 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018299 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18300 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18301 LDAP v3.
18302 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18303 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018305ssl_f_serial : binary
18306 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18307 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18308 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018309
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018310ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18311 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18312 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18313 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18316 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18317 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18318 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018320ssl_f_version : integer
18321 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18322 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18323
18324ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018325 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18326 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18327 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329 Example :
18330 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18331 listen http-https
18332 bind :80
18333 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18334 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18335
18336ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18337 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18338 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18339
18340ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018341 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18343 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18344 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18345 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18346 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18347 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18348 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18349 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351ssl_fc_cipher : string
18352 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18353 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018354
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018355ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18356 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18357 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018358 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018359
18360ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18361 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18362 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018363 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018364
18365ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18366 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18367 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18368 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018369 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018370 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018371
18372ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18373 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18374 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018375 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018376
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018377ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18378 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18379 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18380 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18381
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018382ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18383 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18384 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18385 transport layer.
18386 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18387 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18388 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18389 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18390
18391ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18392 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18393 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18394 transport layer.
18395 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18396 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18397 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18398 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18399
18400ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18401 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18402 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18403 transport layer.
18404 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18405 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18406 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18407 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18408
18409ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18410 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18411 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18412 transport layer.
18413 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18414 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18415 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18416 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18417
18418ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18419 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18420 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18421 transport layer.
18422 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18423 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18424 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18425 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018427ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018428 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18429 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018430 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18431 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18432 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18433 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018434
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018435ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18436 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18437 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18438 wait until the handshake happened.
18439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018440ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18441 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018442 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18443 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018444 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018445 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018446
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018447ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018448 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018449 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18450 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018453 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018454 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18455 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18456 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18457 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18458 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18459 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18460 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462ssl_fc_protocol : string
18463 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18464 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018465
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018466ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018467 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018468 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18469 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018470
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018471ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18472 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18473 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18474 transport layer.
18475 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18476 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18477 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18478 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18479
18480ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18481 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18482 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18483 transport layer.
18484 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18485 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18486 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18487 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18488
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018489ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18490 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18491 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18492 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18495 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18496 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18497 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18498 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018499
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018500ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18501 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18502 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18503 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18504 BoringSSL.
18505
18506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018507ssl_fc_sni : string
18508 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18509 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18510 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18511 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18512 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18513
18514 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18515 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18516 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018517 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018518 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018521 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18522 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018524ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18525 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18526 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018527
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018528ssl_s_der : binary
18529 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18530 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18531 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18532
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018533ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18534 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18535 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18536 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018537 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018538 does not support resumed sessions.
18539
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018540ssl_s_key_alg : string
18541 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18542 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18543 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18544
18545ssl_s_notafter : string
18546 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18547 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18548 transport layer.
18549
18550ssl_s_notbefore : string
18551 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18552 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18553 transport layer.
18554
18555ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18556 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18557 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18558 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18559 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18560 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18561 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018562 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18563 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018564 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18565 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18566 LDAP v3.
18567 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18568 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18569
18570ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18571 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18572 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18573 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18574 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18575 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18576 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018577 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18578 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018579 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18580 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18581 LDAP v3.
18582 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18583 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18584
18585ssl_s_serial : binary
18586 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18587 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18588 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18589
18590ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18591 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18592 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18593 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18594
18595ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18596 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18597 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18598 layer.
18599
18600ssl_s_version : integer
18601 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18602 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018603
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200186047.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018605------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18608sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18609only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18610For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18611be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18612can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18613sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18614for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18615content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018616
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018617Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18618 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18619 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18620 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18621 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18622 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18623 sample expression). So be careful.
18624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018626 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018627 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18628 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018630payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18631 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018632 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635req.len : integer
18636req_len : integer (deprecated)
18637 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18638 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18639 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18640 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18641 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18642 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18643 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18644 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018646req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18647 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018648 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18649 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18650 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18651 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653 ACL alternatives :
18654 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018656req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18657 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18658 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18659 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18660 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018662 ACL alternatives :
18663 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018667req.proto_http : boolean
18668req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18669 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18670 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18671 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18672 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18673 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18674 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18675 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018677 Example:
18678 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18679 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18680 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018681 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18684rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18685 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18686 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18687 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18688 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18689 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18690 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18691 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18694 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18695 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18696 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18697 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18698 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700 ACL derivatives :
18701 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018703 Example :
18704 listen tse-farm
18705 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18706 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18707 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18708 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18709 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18710 persist rdp-cookie
18711 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18712 # This is only useful makes sense if
18713 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18714 stick-table type string size 204800
18715 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18716 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18717 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018719 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18720 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018722req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18723rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18724 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18725 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18726 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18727 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729 ACL derivatives :
18730 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018731
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018732req.ssl_alpn : string
18733 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18734 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18735 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18736 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18737 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18738 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018739 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018740
18741 Examples :
18742 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18743 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18744 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018745 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018746 default_backend bk_default
18747
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018748req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18749 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18750 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018751 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18752 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18753 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18754 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18755 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18758req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18759 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18760 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18761 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18762 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18763 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18764 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18765 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018767req.ssl_sni : string
18768req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18769 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18770 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18771 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18772 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18773 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018774 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18775 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18776 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18777 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18778 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18779 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18780 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18781 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18782 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018784 ACL derivatives :
18785 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787 Examples :
18788 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18789 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18790 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18791 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18792 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018793
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018794req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18795 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18796 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18797 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18798 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18799 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18800 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18801 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18802 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18803 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805req.ssl_ver : integer
18806req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18807 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18808 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18809 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18810 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18811 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18812 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18813 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018814 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018815 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817 ACL derivatives :
18818 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018819
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018820res.len : integer
18821 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18822 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18823 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18824 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18825 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18826 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18827 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018828 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018830res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18831 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018832 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018833 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018834 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018835 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18838 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18839 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18840 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018841 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18842 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018845
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018846res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18847rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18848 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18849 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18850 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18851 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18852 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18853 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18854 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856wait_end : boolean
18857 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18858 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018859 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18861 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018862 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18864 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018866 Examples :
18867 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18868 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18869 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18872 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18873 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18874 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18875 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18876 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18877 tcp-request content reject
18878
18879
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188807.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881--------------------------------------
18882
18883It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18884This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18885data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18886its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18887HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18888content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18889to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18890more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18891response are indexed.
18892
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018893Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18894 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18895 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18896 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18897 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18898 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18899 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901base : string
18902 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18903 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18904 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18905 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18906 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18907 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18908 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18909 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18910
18911 ACL derivatives :
18912 base : exact string match
18913 base_beg : prefix match
18914 base_dir : subdir match
18915 base_dom : domain match
18916 base_end : suffix match
18917 base_len : length match
18918 base_reg : regex match
18919 base_sub : substring match
18920
18921base32 : integer
18922 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18923 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18924 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018925 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18926 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18927 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018928
18929base32+src : binary
18930 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18931 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18932 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18933 per-URL counters.
18934
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018935baseq : string
18936 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18937 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18938 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18939 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18940
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018941capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18942 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18943 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18944 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18945
18946capture.req.method : string
18947 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18948 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18949 because it's allocated.
18950
18951capture.req.uri : string
18952 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18953 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18954 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18955 allocated.
18956
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018957capture.req.ver : string
18958 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18959 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18960 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18961
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018962capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18963 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18964 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18965 The first entry is an index of 0.
18966 See also: "capture response header"
18967
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018968capture.res.ver : string
18969 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18970 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18971 persistent flag.
18972
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018973req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018974 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18975 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18976 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018977
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018978req.body_param([<name>) : string
18979 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18980 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18981 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18982 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18983 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18984 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18985 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18986 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18987 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18988 given.
18989
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018990req.body_len : integer
18991 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18992 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018993 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18994 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018995
18996req.body_size : integer
18997 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018998 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18999 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019001req.cook([<name>]) : string
19002cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19003 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19004 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19005 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19006 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19007 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19008 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19009 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19010 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19011
19012 ACL derivatives :
19013 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19014 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19015 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19016 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19017 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19018 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19019 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19020 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19023cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19024 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19025 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019027req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19028cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19029 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19030 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19031 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19032 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019034cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19035 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19036 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19037 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19038 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019039 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019040 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19041 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19042 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19043 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19046 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19047 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19048 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19049 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019050 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019052req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019053 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19054 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19055 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19056 with headers such as User-Agent.
19057
19058 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19059 found.
19060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19062 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19063 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019064 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019066req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19067 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19068 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019069 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19070 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019073 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19074 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19075 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19076 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19077 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19078 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19079 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19080
19081 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19082 found.
19083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019084 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19085 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19086 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019087 with -1 being the last one.
19088
19089 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19090 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092 ACL derivatives :
19093 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19094 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19095 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19096 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19097 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19098 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19099 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19100 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19101
19102req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19103hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19104 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19105 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019106 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19107 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19108 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19109
19110 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19111 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19112 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19113
19114 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019115
19116req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19117hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19118 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19119 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19120 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019121 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19122 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19123 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19124 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19125 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019126
19127 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19128
19129 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019130
19131req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19132hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19133 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19134 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19135 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019136
19137 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19138
19139 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019141req.hdrs : string
19142 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19143 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19144 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19145 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19146
19147req.hdrs_bin : binary
19148 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19149 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19150 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19151 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19152 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19153 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19154
19155 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019156
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019157 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19158 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019160http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19161 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19162 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19163 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19164 basic auth is supported.
19165
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019166http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19167 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19168 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19169 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19170 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019171 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19172 basic auth is supported.
19173
19174 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019175 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19176 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19177 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19178 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019180http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019181 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19182 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19183 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019184
19185http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019186 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19187 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19188 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019189
19190http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019191 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19192 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19193 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019195http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019196 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19197 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19199 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019201method : integer + string
19202 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19203 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19204 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19205 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19206 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19207 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19208 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210 ACL derivatives :
19211 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213 Example :
19214 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19215 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19216 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019218path : string
19219 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19220 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19221 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19222 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19223 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019224 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019227 ACL derivatives :
19228 path : exact string match
19229 path_beg : prefix match
19230 path_dir : subdir match
19231 path_dom : domain match
19232 path_end : suffix match
19233 path_len : length match
19234 path_reg : regex match
19235 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019236
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019237pathq : string
19238 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19239 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19240 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19241 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19242 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19243 result in both cases.
19244
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019245query : string
19246 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19247 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19248 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19249 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019250 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019251 which stops before the question mark.
19252
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019253req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19254 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19255 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19256 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19257 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259req.ver : string
19260req_ver : string (deprecated)
19261 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19262 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19263 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265 ACL derivatives :
19266 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019267
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019268res.body : binary
19269 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19270 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019271 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19272
19273 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019274
19275res.body_len : integer
19276 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19277 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019278 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19279
19280 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019281
19282res.body_size : integer
19283 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19284 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19285 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19286 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019287 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19288
19289 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019290
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019291res.cache_hit : boolean
19292 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19293 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19294
19295res.cache_name : string
19296 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19297 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19298 empty string.
19299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019300res.comp : boolean
19301 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19302 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19303 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019305res.comp_algo : string
19306 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19307 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19308 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019310res.cook([<name>]) : string
19311scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19312 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19313 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019314 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19315
19316 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019318 ACL derivatives :
19319 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019321res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19322scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19323 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19324 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019325 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19326
19327 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019329res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19330scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19331 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19332 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019333 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19334
19335 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019337res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019338 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19339 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19340
19341 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19342 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19343
19344 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19345
19346 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019349 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19350 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19351
19352 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19353 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19354
19355 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019357res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19358shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019359 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19360 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19361
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019362 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019363 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19364
19365 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019367 ACL derivatives :
19368 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19369 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19370 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19371 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19372 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19373 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19374 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19375 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19376
19377res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19378shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019379 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19380 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19381
19382 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019383 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019384
19385 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019387res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19388shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019389 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19390 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19391
19392 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19393
19394 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019395
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019396res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19397 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19398 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19399 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019400 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19401
19402 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019404res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19405shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019406 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19407 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19408
19409 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19410
19411 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019412
19413res.hdrs : string
19414 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19415 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19416 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019417 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19418
19419 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019420
19421res.hdrs_bin : binary
19422 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19423 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19424 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19425 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19426 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19427 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19428 (length of 0 for both).
19429
19430 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19431
19432 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19433 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435res.ver : string
19436resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19437 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019438 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19439
19440 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019442 ACL derivatives :
19443 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019445set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19446 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19447 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019448 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019451 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19452 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019454status : integer
19455 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19456 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019457 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19458
19459 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019460
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019461unique-id : string
19462 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19463 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19464 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19465 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19466 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19467 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019469url : string
19470 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19471 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19472 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19473 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19474 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19475 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19476 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478 ACL derivatives :
19479 url : exact string match
19480 url_beg : prefix match
19481 url_dir : subdir match
19482 url_dom : domain match
19483 url_end : suffix match
19484 url_len : length match
19485 url_reg : regex match
19486 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019488url_ip : ip
19489 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19490 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19491 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19492 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19493 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19494 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19495 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019497url_port : integer
19498 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19499 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19500 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19501 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019502
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019503urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19504url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019505 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19506 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019507 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19508 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19509 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19510 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019511 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19512 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019513 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19514 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019516 ACL derivatives :
19517 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19518 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19519 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19520 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19521 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19522 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19523 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19524 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019525
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019527 Example :
19528 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19529 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19530 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19531 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019532
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019533urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019534 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19535 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19536 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019537
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019538url32 : integer
19539 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19540 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19541 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19542 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19543 is an unsigned integer.
19544
19545url32+src : binary
19546 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19547 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19548 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19549
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019550
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200195517.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019552---------------------------------------
19553
19554This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19555used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19556purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19557There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19558or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19559any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19560for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19561
19562internal.htx.data : integer
19563 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19564 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19565
19566internal.htx.free : integer
19567 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19568 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19569
19570internal.htx.free_data : integer
19571 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19572 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19573
19574internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019575 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19576 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19577 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019578
19579internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19580 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19581 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19582
19583internal.htx.size : integer
19584 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19585 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19586
19587internal.htx.used : integer
19588 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19589 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19590 direction.
19591
19592internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19593 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19594 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19595 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19596 of the special value :
19597 * head : The oldest inserted block
19598 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019599 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019600
19601internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19602 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19603 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19604 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19605 integer or one of the special value :
19606 * head : The oldest inserted block
19607 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019608 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019609
19610internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19611 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19612 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19613 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19614 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19615
19616 * head : The oldest inserted block
19617 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019618 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019619
19620internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19621 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19622 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19623 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19624 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19625
19626 * head : The oldest inserted block
19627 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019628 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019629
19630internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19631 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19632 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19633 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19634 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19635
19636 * head : The oldest inserted block
19637 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019638 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019639
19640internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19641 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19642 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19643 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19644 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19645
19646 * head : The oldest inserted block
19647 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019648 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019649
19650internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19651 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19652 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19653 it returns false.
19654
19655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200196567.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019657---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019659Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19660every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019661order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019663ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019664---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19665FALSE always_false never match
19666HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19667HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19668HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019669HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019670HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19671HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19672HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19673HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19674LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19675METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19676METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19677METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19678METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19679METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19680METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19681METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19682METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19683RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19684REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19685TRUE always_true always match
19686WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19687---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019688
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196908. Logging
19691----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019693One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19694provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19695very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19696provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19697state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019698to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019699headers.
19700
19701In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19702about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19703send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19704
19705 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19706 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19707 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19708 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19709 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019710 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019711 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019712
19713The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19714allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19715as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19716while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19717real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19718delay.
19719
19720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197218.1. Log levels
19722---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019723
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019724TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019725source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019726HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19727in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19728track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19729syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19730about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019731
19732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197338.2. Log formats
19734----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019736HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019737and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19738slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19739options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019740
19741 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19742 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19743 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19744 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19745 extents.
19746
19747 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19748 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19749 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19750 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19751 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19752
19753 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19754 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19755 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19756 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19757 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19758
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019759 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19760 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19761 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19762 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19763
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019764 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19765
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019766Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19767specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19768field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19769servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19770always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19771identifier.
19772
19773Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19774 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19775 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19776 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19777 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19778
19779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197808.2.1. Default log format
19781-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019782
19783This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19784as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19785format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19786
19787 Example :
19788 listen www
19789 mode http
19790 log global
19791 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19792
19793 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19794 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19795 (www/HTTP)
19796
19797 Field Format Extract from the example above
19798 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19799 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19800 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19801 4 'to' to
19802 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19803 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19804
19805Detailed fields description :
19806 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19807 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19808 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19809 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19810 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19811 and processed the connection.
19812 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19813
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019814In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19815"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19816connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19817
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019818It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19819will eventually disappear.
19820
19821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198228.2.2. TCP log format
19823---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019824
19825The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19826is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19827information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19828counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19829emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19830environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19831the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19832sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019833specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19834not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19835fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19836marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019837
19838 Example :
19839 frontend fnt
19840 mode tcp
19841 option tcplog
19842 log global
19843 default_backend bck
19844
19845 backend bck
19846 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19847
19848 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19849 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19850 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19851
19852 Field Format Extract from the example above
19853 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19854 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19855 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19856 4 frontend_name fnt
19857 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19858 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19859 7 bytes_read* 212
19860 8 termination_state --
19861 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19862 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19863
19864Detailed fields description :
19865 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019866 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19867 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19868 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019869 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019870 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019871 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019872
19873 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019874 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19875 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19876 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019877
19878 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19879 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19880 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019881 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19882 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19883 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19884 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019885
19886 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19887 and processed the connection.
19888
19889 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19890 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19891 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19892 applications.
19893
19894 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19895 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19896 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19897 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19898 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19899
19900 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19901 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19902 See "Timers" below for more details.
19903
19904 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19905 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19906 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19907 "Timers" below for more details.
19908
19909 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019910 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019911 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19912 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19913 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19914 details.
19915
19916 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19917 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19918 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19919 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19920 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19921
19922 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19923 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19924 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19925 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19926 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19927 for more details.
19928
19929 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019930 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019931 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19932 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19933 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019934 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019935
19936 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19937 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19938 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19939 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19940 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19941 caused by a denial of service attack.
19942
19943 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19944 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19945 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19946 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19947 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19948 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19949 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19950 denial of service attack.
19951
19952 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19953 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19954 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19955 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19956 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19957 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19958 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19959 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19960 be processed than on other servers.
19961
19962 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19963 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19964 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19965 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19966 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19967 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19968 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19969 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19970 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19971 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19972 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19973 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19974 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19975
19976 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19977 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19978 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19979 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19980 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19981 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019982 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019983 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19984
19985 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19986 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19987 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19988 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19989 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19990 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019991 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019992 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19993 occurs.
19994
19995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199968.2.3. HTTP log format
19997----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019998
19999The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20000is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20001the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20002are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20003emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20004generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20005"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20006which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020007frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20008is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020009
20010Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20011slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20012with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20013
20014 Example :
20015 frontend http-in
20016 mode http
20017 option httplog
20018 log global
20019 default_backend bck
20020
20021 backend static
20022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20023
20024 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20025 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20026 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020027 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020028
20029 Field Format Extract from the example above
20030 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20031 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020032 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020033 4 frontend_name http-in
20034 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020035 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020036 7 status_code 200
20037 8 bytes_read* 2750
20038 9 captured_request_cookie -
20039 10 captured_response_cookie -
20040 11 termination_state ----
20041 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20042 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20043 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20044 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20045 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020046
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020047Detailed fields description :
20048 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020049 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20050 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20051 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020052 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020053 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020054 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020055
20056 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020057 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20058 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20059 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020060
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020061 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20062 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020063
20064 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20065 and processed the connection.
20066
20067 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20068 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20069 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20070
20071 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20072 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20073 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20074 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20075 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20076 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20077
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020078 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20079 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20080 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020081 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020082 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20083 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020084 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20085 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020086
20087 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20088 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020089 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020090
20091 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20092 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020093 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20094 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020095
20096 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20097 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20098 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20099 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20100 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020101 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20102 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020104 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20105 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20106 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20107 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20108 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20109 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20110 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020111 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020112
20113 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20114 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20115 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20116
20117 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20118 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020119 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020120 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20121 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20122 overflowing.
20123
20124 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20125 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20126 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20127 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20128 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20129 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20130 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20131 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20132
20133 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20134 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20135 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20136 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20137 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20138 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20139 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20140 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20141
20142 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20143 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20144 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20145 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20146 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20147 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20148 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20149
20150 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020151 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020152 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20153 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20154 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020155 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020156 system.
20157
20158 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20159 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20160 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20161 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20162 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20163 caused by a denial of service attack.
20164
20165 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20166 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20167 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20168 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20169 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20170 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20171 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20172 denial of service attack.
20173
20174 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20175 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20176 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20177 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20178 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20179 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20180 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20181 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20182 processed than on other servers.
20183
20184 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20185 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20186 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20187 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20188 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20189 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20190 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20191 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20192 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20193 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20194 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20195 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20196 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20197
20198 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20199 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20200 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20201 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20202 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20203 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020204 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020205 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20206
20207 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20208 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20209 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20210 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20211 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20212 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020213 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20215 occurs.
20216
20217 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20218 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20219 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20220 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20221 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20222 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20223 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20224 cookies" below for more details.
20225
20226 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20227 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20228 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20229 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20230 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20231 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20232 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20233 and cookies" below for more details.
20234
20235 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20236 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20237 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20238 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20239 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20240 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20241 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20242 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20243
20244
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200202458.2.4. Custom log format
20246------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020247
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020248The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020249mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020251HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020252Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20253separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20254prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20255
20256Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20257variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020258("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020259
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020260If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020261as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020262less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20263the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20264
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020265Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20266"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20267delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20268preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020269
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020270Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20271'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20272https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20273such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20274
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020275Flags are :
20276 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020277 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020278 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20279 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020280
20281 Example:
20282
20283 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20284 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20285
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020286 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20287
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020288At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20289
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020290 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20291 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020292
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020293the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020294
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020295 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20296 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20297 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020298
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020299and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20300
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020301 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20302 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020303
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020304Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20305
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020306 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020307 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020308 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20309 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20310 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020311 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20312 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20313 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020314 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020315 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020316 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020317 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020318 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020319 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20320 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020321 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020322 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020323 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020324 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020325 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020326 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020327 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020328 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20329 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20330 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20331 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20332 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020333 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020334 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020335 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020336 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020337 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020338 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20339 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020340 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20341 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20342 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020343 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020344 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20345 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020346 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020347 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20348 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20349 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020350 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020351 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020352 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20353 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20354 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20355 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020356 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020357 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020358 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020359 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020360 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020361 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020362 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20363 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20364 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020365 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020366 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20367 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020368 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020369 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20370 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020371 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020372 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020373 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020374 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020375
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020376 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020377
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020378
203798.2.5. Error log format
20380-----------------------
20381
20382When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20383protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20384By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20385"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020386will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020387logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20388
20389The format looks like this :
20390
20391 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20392 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20393 Connection error during SSL handshake
20394
20395 Field Format Extract from the example above
20396 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20397 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20398 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20399 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20400 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20401
20402These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20403failures.
20404
20405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204068.3. Advanced logging options
20407-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020408
20409Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20410just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20411options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20412for more information about their usage.
20413
20414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204158.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20416------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020417
20418It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20419haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20420commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20421monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20422ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20423
20424 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20425 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20426 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20427 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20428
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020429 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20430 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020431
20432 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20433 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20434 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20435
20436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204378.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20438----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020439
20440The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20441what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20442or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020443"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020444just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20445log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20446after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20447is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20448with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20449with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20450
20451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204528.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20453------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020454
20455Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20456for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20457"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20458retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20459raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20460a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20461file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20462you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20463"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20464
20465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204668.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20467--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020468
20469Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20470multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20471them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20472"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20473logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20474error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20475and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20476too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20477useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20478alternative.
20479
20480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204818.4. Timing events
20482------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020483
20484Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20485reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20486the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20487frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020488mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20489addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20490
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020491Timings events in HTTP mode:
20492
20493 first request 2nd request
20494 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20495 t tr t tr ...
20496 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20497 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20498 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20499 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020500 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020501 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20502
20503Timings events in TCP mode:
20504
20505 TCP session
20506 |<----------------->|
20507 t t
20508 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20509 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20510 |<------ Tt ------->|
20511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020512 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020513 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020514 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20515 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20516 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020517 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020518 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20519 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20520 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20521 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020522
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020523 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20524 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20525 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020526 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20527 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20528 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20529 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20530 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20531 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020532
20533 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20534 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20535 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20536 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20537 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20538 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20539 request typed by hand during a test.
20540
20541 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20542 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020543 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020544 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20545 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20546 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20547 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020548
20549 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20550 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20551 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20552 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20553 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20554
20555 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20556 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20557 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20558 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20559 connection never established.
20560
20561 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20562 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20563 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20564 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20565 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20566 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20567 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20568 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20569 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20570 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20571 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20572
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020573 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20574 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20575 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20576 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20577 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20578 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20579
20580 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20581
20582 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20583 "Ta" can never be negative.
20584
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020585 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20586 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020587 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20588 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020589 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020590
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020591 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020592
20593 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020594 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20595 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020596
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020597 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20598 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20599 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20600 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20601 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20602 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20603 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20604 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020606These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20607protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20608that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020609due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20610"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20611that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020612
20613Most common cases :
20614
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020615 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20616 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20617 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20618 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20619 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20620 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20621 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20622 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20623 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20624 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20625 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020626 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020627
20628 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20629 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20630 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20631 of ms on remote networks.
20632
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020633 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20634 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20635 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020637 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20638 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20639 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20640 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20641 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20642 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20643 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20644 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20645 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020646
20647Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20648
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020649 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020650 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020651 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020652
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020653 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020654 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20655 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20656
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020657 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020658 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20659 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20660 flags.
20661
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020662 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20663 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020664 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20665 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20666 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20667 the client connection was maintained open.
20668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020669 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020670 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020671 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020672 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20673
20674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206758.5. Session state at disconnection
20676-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020677
20678TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20679"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
206802-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20681each of which has a special meaning :
20682
20683 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20684 session to terminate :
20685
20686 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20687
20688 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20689 server explicitly refused it.
20690
20691 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20692 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20693 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20694 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020695 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020696
20697 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20698 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020699
20700 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20701 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20702 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20703 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20704 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20705
20706 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20707 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20708 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20709 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20710 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20711
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020712 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20713 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20714
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020715 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20716 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20717 backup connections when going up.
20718
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020719 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20720
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020721 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20722 send or receive data.
20723
20724 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20725 send or receive data.
20726
20727 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20728 with nothing left in the buffers.
20729
20730 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20731
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020732 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020733 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20734
20735 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20736 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20737 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20738 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20739 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20740
20741 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20742 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20743
20744 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20745 server (HTTP only).
20746
20747 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20748
20749 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20750 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20751 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20752
20753 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20754 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20755 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20756
20757 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20758
20759 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20760 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20761
20762 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20763 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20764 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20765
20766 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20767 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020768 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20769 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020770
20771 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20772 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20773 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20774 another server.
20775
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020776 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020777 server.
20778
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020779 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20780 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20781 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20782 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20783
20784 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20785 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20786 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20787 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20788
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020789 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20790 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20791 "use-server" rule).
20792
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020793 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20794
20795 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20796 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20797
20798 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20799
20800 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20801 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20802 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20803
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020804 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20805 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020806 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020807 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20808 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020810 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20811
20812 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20813 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20814
20815 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20816
20817 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20818
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020819The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20820was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020821helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20822starvation, attacks, etc...
20823
20824The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20825alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20826easier finding and understanding.
20827
20828 Flags Reason
20829
20830 -- Normal termination.
20831
20832 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20833 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20834 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20835 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20836
20837 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20838 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20839 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20840 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20841 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20842 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020843
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020844 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20845 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020846 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020847
20848 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20849 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20850 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20851
20852 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20853 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20854 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20855 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20856 the server takes too long to respond.
20857
20858 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20859 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20860 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20861 long a time to respond.
20862
20863 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20864 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20865 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20866 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020867 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20868 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020869
20870 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20871 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20872 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20873 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20874 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020875 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020876 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20877 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20878 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20879 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20880 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20881 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20882 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20883 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020884 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020885 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20886 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20887 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020888
20889 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20890 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020891 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20892 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20893 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20894 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020895
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020896 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20897 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020899 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020900 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20901 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020902 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020903 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20904 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20905
20906 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20907 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20908 503 or 504 here.
20909
20910 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20911 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20912 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20913 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20914 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20915
20916 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20917 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020918 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020919 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20920 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20921
20922 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20923 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20924 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20925 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20926 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20927 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20928 between haproxy and the server.
20929
20930 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20931 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20932 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20933 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20934 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20935 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20936 solution is to fix the application.
20937
20938 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20939 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20940 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20941 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20942 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20943 external attacks.
20944
20945 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020946 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020947 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020948 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20949 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20950
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020951 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20952 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20953 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020954 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020955 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020957 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20958 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20959 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20960 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020961 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20962 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20963 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20964 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20965 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020966
20967 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20968 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20969 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20970 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20971
20972 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20973 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20974 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20975 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20976
20977 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20978 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20979 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20980 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20981
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020982The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20983persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20984important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20985re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20986
20987 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20988
20989 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20990 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20991 set on a GET request.
20992
20993 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20994 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020995 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020996 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20997
20998 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20999 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21000 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21001
21002 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21003 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21004 already got a cookie.
21005
21006 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21007 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21008 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21009 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21010 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21011
21012 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21013 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21014 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21015
21016 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21017 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21018 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21019
21020 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21021 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21022
21023 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21024 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21025 then advertised in the response.
21026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210288.6. Non-printable characters
21029-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021030
21031In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21032consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21033converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21034prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21035being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21036escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21037is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21038'}' when logging headers.
21039
21040Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21041issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21042containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21043
21044Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21045the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21046performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21047
21048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210498.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21050---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021051
21052Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21053achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021054section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21056the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21057the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021058locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021059not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21060user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21061a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21062wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21063
21064 Examples :
21065 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21066 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21067
21068 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21069 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21070
21071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210728.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21073---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021074
21075Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21076proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21077the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21078server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21079
21080Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21081response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021082section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021083
21084It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021085time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21086appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021087are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21088and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21089follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21090request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21091in the logs.
21092
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021093As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21094frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21095an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021097 Example :
21098 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21099 listen proxy-out
21100 mode http
21101 option httplog
21102 option logasap
21103 log global
21104 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21105
21106 # log the name of the virtual server
21107 capture request header Host len 20
21108
21109 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21110 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21111
21112 # log the beginning of the referrer
21113 capture request header Referer len 20
21114
21115 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21116 capture response header Server len 20
21117
21118 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21119 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021121 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021122 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21123
21124 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21125 capture response header Via len 20
21126
21127 # log the URL location during a redirection
21128 capture response header Location len 20
21129
21130 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21131 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21132 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21133 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21134 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21135
21136 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21137 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21138 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21139 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021140 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021141
21142 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21143 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21144 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21145 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21146 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021147 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021148
21149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211508.9. Examples of logs
21151---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021152
21153These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21154them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21155reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21156
21157 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21158 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21159 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21160
21161 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21162 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21163
21164 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21165 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21166 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21167
21168 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21169 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21170
21171 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21172 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21173 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21174
21175 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021176 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021177 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21178 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21179
21180 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21181 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21182 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21183
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021184 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21185 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21186 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21187 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21188 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21189 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021190
21191 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021192 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021193
21194 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21195 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21196 Nothing was sent to any server.
21197
21198 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21199 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21200
21201 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21202 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021203 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021204 send a 408 return code to the client.
21205
21206 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21207 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21208
21209 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21210 5 seconds ("c----").
21211
21212 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21213 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021214 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021215
21216 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021217 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021218 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21219 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21220 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21221 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21222 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021223
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021224
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200212259. Supported filters
21226--------------------
21227
21228Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21229accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21230unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21231
21232See also : "filter"
21233
212349.1. Trace
21235----------
21236
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021237filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021238
21239 Arguments:
21240 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21241 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21242
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021243 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021245 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021246 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21247 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21248 amount of the parsed data.
21249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021250 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021251
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021252This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21253callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21254information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21255filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21256
21257Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21258tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21259a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21260
21261
212629.2. HTTP compression
21263---------------------
21264
21265filter compression
21266
21267The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21268keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021269when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21270fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21271done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21272explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21273filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21274listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21275order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021276
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021277See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21278 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021279
21280
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200212819.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21282--------------------------------------------
21283
21284filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21285
21286 Arguments :
21287
21288 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21289 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21290 parsed.
21291
21292 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21293 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21294 part must be placed in its own scope.
21295
21296The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21297external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021298streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021299exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21300also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21301
21302SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21303the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21304
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021305For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021306"doc/SPOE.txt".
21307
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100213089.4. Cache
21309----------
21310
21311filter cache <name>
21312
21313 Arguments :
21314
21315 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21316
21317The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21318"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021319cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021320other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21321case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21322is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21323filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021324listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21325order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021326
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021327See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21328 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21329
21330
213319.5. Fcgi-app
21332-------------
21333
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021334filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021335
21336 Arguments :
21337
21338 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21339
21340The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21341request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21342reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21343used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21344implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21345used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21346fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21347used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21348order.
21349
21350See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21351 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21352
21353
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100213549.6. OpenTracing
21355----------------
21356
21357The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21358HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21359of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21360Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21361
21362This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21363
21364The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21365HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21366participates in the work of HAProxy.
21367
21368filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21369
21370 Arguments :
21371
21372 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21373 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21374 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21375 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21376 OpenTracing filters.
21377
21378 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21379 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21380 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21381 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21382 filter must have its own scope defined.
21383
21384More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021385of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021386
21387
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002138810. FastCGI applications
21389-------------------------
21390
21391HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21392feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21393the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21394FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21395servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21396FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21397backend.
21398
21399HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21400application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21401connection.
21402
2140310.1. Setup
21404-----------
21405
2140610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21407--------------------------
21408
21409fcgi-app <name>
21410 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21411 document root must be defined.
21412
21413acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21414 Declare or complete an access list.
21415
21416 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21417 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21418 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21419 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21420 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21421
21422docroot <path>
21423 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21424 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21425 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21426
21427index <script-name>
21428 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21429 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21430 is an optional setting.
21431
21432 Example :
21433 index index.php
21434
21435log-stderr global
21436log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021437 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021438 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21439
21440 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21441 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21442
21443pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21444 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21445 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21446 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21447
21448 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21449 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21450 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21451 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21452
21453 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21454 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21455
21456path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021457 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021458 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21459 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21460 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21461 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21462 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21463 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21464 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021465
21466 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021467 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021468 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21469 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21470 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21471 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021472
21473 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021474 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21475 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021476
21477option get-values
21478no option get-values
21479 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21480
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021481 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021482 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21483
21484 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21485 application will accept.
21486
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021487 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21488 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021489
21490 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021491 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021492 option is disabled.
21493
21494 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21495 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21496 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21497 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21498 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21499 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21500
21501option keep-conn
21502no option keep-conn
21503 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21504 sending a response.
21505
21506 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21507 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21508
21509option max-reqs <reqs>
21510 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21511 accept.
21512
21513 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21514 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21515 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21516 to 1.
21517
21518option mpxs-conns
21519no option mpxs-conns
21520 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21521
21522 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21523 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21524
21525set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21526 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21527 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21528 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21529 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21530
21531 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21532 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21533 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21534
21535 Example :
21536 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21537 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21538
21539 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21540
21541
2154210.1.2. Proxy section
21543---------------------
21544
21545use-fcgi-app <name>
21546 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21547
21548 Arguments :
21549 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21550
21551 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21552 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21553 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21554 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21555 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21556
21557 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21558 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21559 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21560 application are evaluated.
21561
21562
2156310.1.3. Example
21564---------------
21565
21566 frontend front-http
21567 mode http
21568 bind *:80
21569 bind *:
21570
21571 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21572 default_backend back-static
21573
21574 backend back-static
21575 mode http
21576 server www A.B.C.D:80
21577
21578 backend back-dynamic
21579 mode http
21580 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21581 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21582
21583 fcgi-app php-fpm
21584 log-stderr global
21585 option keep-conn
21586
21587 docroot /var/www/my-app
21588 index index.php
21589 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21590
21591
2159210.2. Default parameters
21593------------------------
21594
21595A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21596the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021597script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021598applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21599
21600 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21601 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21602 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21603 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21604 | | |
21605 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21606 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21607 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21608 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21609 | | application. |
21610 | | |
21611 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21612 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21613 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21614 | | |
21615 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21616 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21617 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21618 | | the application's configuration. |
21619 | | |
21620 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21621 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21622 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21623 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21624 | | |
21625 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21626 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21627 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21628 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21629 | | be defined. |
21630 | | |
21631 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21632 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21633 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21634 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21635 | | is not set too. |
21636 | | |
21637 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21638 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21639 | | set. |
21640 | | |
21641 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21642 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21643 | | the request. |
21644 | | |
21645 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21646 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21647 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21648 | | |
21649 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21650 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21651 | | script to process the request. |
21652 | | |
21653 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21654 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21655 | | |
21656 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21657 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21658 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21659 | | |
21660 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21661 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21662 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21663 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21664 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21665 | | |
21666 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21667 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21668 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21669 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21670 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21671 | | side. |
21672 | | |
21673 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21674 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21675 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21676 | | connected to. |
21677 | | |
21678 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21679 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21680 | | |
21681 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21682 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21683 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21684 | | |
21685 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21686
21687
2168810.3. Limitations
21689------------------
21690
21691The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21692way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21693during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21694establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21695application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21696or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21697message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21698these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21699and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21700
21701Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21702request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21703requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21704
21705About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21706into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21707fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21708"http-request" ones.
21709
21710Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21711FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21712processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21713must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21714here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021715
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021716
2171711. Address formats
21718-------------------
21719
21720Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21721address.
21722
21723This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21724The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21725of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21726equivalent is '::'.
21727
21728Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21729is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21730
21731This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21732family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21733
21734Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21735configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21736use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21737'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21738
21739Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21740socket type and the transport method.
21741
21742
2174311.1 Address family prefixes
21744----------------------------
21745
21746'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21747
21748'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21749 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21750 listening.
21751
21752'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21753 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21754 on the statement using this address, a port or
21755 a port range may or must be specified.
21756
21757'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21758 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21759 using this address, a port or a port range
21760 may or must be specified.
21761
21762'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21763 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21764 using this address, a port or a port range
21765 may or must be specified.
21766
21767'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21768 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21769 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21770 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21771 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21772 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21773
21774'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21775 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21776 start by slash '/'.
21777
21778
2177911.2 Socket type prefixes
21780-------------------------
21781
21782Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21783type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21784this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21785This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21786but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21787
21788Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21789instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21790
21791If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21792they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21793report this to the maintainers.
21794
21795'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21796 to "stream"
21797
21798'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21799 to "datagram".
21800
21801
2180211.3 Protocol prefixes
21803----------------------
21804
21805'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21806 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21807 socket type and transport method is forced to
21808 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21809 this address, a port or a port range can or
21810 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21811 of 'stream+ip@'.
21812
21813'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21814 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21815 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21816 statement using this address, a port or port
21817 range can or must be specified.
21818 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21819
21820'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21821 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21822 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21823 statement using this address, a port or port
21824 range can or must be specified.
21825 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21826
21827'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21828 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21829 socket type and transport method is forced to
21830 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21831 this address, a port or a port range can or
21832 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21833 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21834
21835'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21836 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21837 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21838 the statement using this address, a port or
21839 port range can or must be specified.
21840 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21841
21842'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21843 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21844 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21845 the statement using this address, a port or
21846 port range can or must be specified.
21847 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21848
21849'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21850 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21851 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21852
21853'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21854 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21855 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21856
21857In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21858QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021860/*
21861 * Local variables:
21862 * fill-column: 79
21863 * End:
21864 */